blob: 2a7efe96b18d670ca62e4f6444aaa6201e76d0e7 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01007 2018/12/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100903 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100905 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
906 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
907 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
908
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100909 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
910 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
911 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
912 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200915 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
916 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
917 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
918 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
919 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
920 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200922 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100924log-send-hostname [<string>]
925 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
926 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
927 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
928 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
929 the logs.
930
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931log-tag <string>
932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
933 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
934 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100935 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100937lua-load <file>
938 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
939 used multiple times.
940
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100941master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200942 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
943 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
944 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200946 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
947 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
949 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
950 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
951 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
952 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956nbproc <number>
957 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
958 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
959 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
960 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
961 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
962
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200963nbthread <number>
964 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
965 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
966 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
967 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
968 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
969
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
973 starting the process. See also "daemon".
974
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100975presetenv <name> <value>
976 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
977 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
978 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
979 and "unsetenv".
980
981resetenv [<name> ...]
982 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
983 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
984 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
985 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
986 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
987 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
988 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
989 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
990
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100991stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200992 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
993 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
994 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
995 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
996 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
997 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100998 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100999 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1000 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1001 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1002 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001003
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001004server-state-base <directory>
1005 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001006 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1007 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001008
1009server-state-file <file>
1010 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1011 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1012 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1013 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1014 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1015 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1016 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1017 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001018 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1019 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001020
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001021setenv <name> <value>
1022 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1023 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1024 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1025 and "unsetenv".
1026
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001027ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1029 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001030 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 for all
1031 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
1032 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance
1033 a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). For
1034 TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites"
1035 keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1036
1037ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1039 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1040 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1041 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1042 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1043 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites", and can
1044 be for instance a string such as
1045 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
1046 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
1047 the "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
1048 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001049
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001050ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1052 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1053 keyword to see available options.
1054
1055 Example:
1056 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001057 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001058
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001059ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1061 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001062 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 with the server,
1063 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
1064 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration,
1065 please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the
1066 "server" keyword for more information.
1067
1068ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1069 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1070 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1071 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1072 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1073 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1074 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration for
1075 TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword.
1076 Please check the "server" keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001077
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001078ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1080 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1081 keyword to see available options.
1082
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001083ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1085 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1086 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001087 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001088 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001089 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1090 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1091 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1092 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001093 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1094 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1095 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1096
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001097ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1098 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1099 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1100 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1101
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001102stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1103 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1104 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1105 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001106 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001107 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001108
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001109 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1110 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1111 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001112
1113stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1114 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1115 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001116 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001117
1118stats maxconn <connections>
1119 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1120 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122uid <number>
1123 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1124 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1125 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1126 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1127
1128ulimit-n <number>
1129 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1130 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1131 option.
1132
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001133unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1134 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1135
1136 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1137 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1138 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1139 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1140 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1141 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1142 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1143 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1144 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1145 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1146
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001147unsetenv [<name> ...]
1148 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1149 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1150 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1151 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1152 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1153 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1154 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1155
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001156user <user name>
1157 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1158 See also "uid" and "group".
1159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001160node <name>
1161 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1162
1163 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1164 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1165 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1166 traffic.
1167
1168description <text>
1169 Add a text that describes the instance.
1170
1171 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1172 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1173 "<" and ">" characters.
1174
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100117551degrees-data-file <file path>
1176 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001178
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001179 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001180 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1181
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000118251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001183 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1184 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1185 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1186
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001187 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001188 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1189
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200119051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001191 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1192 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1193
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001194 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1195 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1196
119751degrees-cache-size <number>
1198 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1199 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1200 By default, this cache is disabled.
1201
1202 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001203 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1204
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001205wurfl-data-file <file path>
1206 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1207 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1208
1209 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1210 with USE_WURFL=1.
1211
1212wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1213 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1214 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1215 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1216
1217 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1218
1219 Valid WURFL properties are:
1220 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1221
1222 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1223 device.
1224
1225 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1226 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1227
1228 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1229 particular web request.
1230
1231 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1232 used Libwurfl API version.
1233
1234 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1235 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1236 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1237
1238 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1239 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1240
1241 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1242 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1243
1244 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1245
1246 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1247
1248 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1249 with USE_WURFL=1.
1250
1251wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1252 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1253 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1254
1255 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1256 with USE_WURFL=1.
1257
1258wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1259 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1260 thus before the chroot.
1261
1262 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1263 with USE_WURFL=1.
1264
1265wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1266 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1267 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001268 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001269 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001270 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001271 mode is enabled by default.
1272
1273 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1274 with USE_WURFL=1.
1275
1276wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1277 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1278 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1279 - "0" : no cache is used.
1280 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1281 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1282 the highest performing option.
1283
1284 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1285 with USE_WURFL=1.
1286
1287wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1288 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1289 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1290
1291 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1292 with USE_WURFL=1.
1293
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012953.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001296-----------------------
1297
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001298busy-polling
1299 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1300 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1301 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1302 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1303 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1304 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1305 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1306 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1307 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1308 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1309 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1310 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1311 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1312 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1313 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1314 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1315 "poll" pollers.
1316
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001317max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1318 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1319 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1320 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1321 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1322 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1323 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1324 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1325 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1326
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327maxconn <number>
1328 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1329 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1330 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001331 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1332 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1333 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1334 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001335 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1336 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1337 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1338 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1339 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001340
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001341maxconnrate <number>
1342 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1343 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1344 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1345 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1346 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1347 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1348 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1349 fairness.
1350
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001351maxcomprate <number>
1352 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001353 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001354 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1355 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1356 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001357 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001358 default value.
1359
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001360maxcompcpuusage <number>
1361 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1362 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1363 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1364 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1365 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1366 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1367 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1368 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1369
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001370maxpipes <number>
1371 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1372 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1373 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1374 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1375 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1376 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1377
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001378maxsessrate <number>
1379 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1380 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1381 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1382 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1383 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1384 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1385 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1386 fairness.
1387
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001388maxsslconn <number>
1389 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1390 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1391 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1392 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1393 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1394 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1395 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001396 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1397 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1398 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1399 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1400 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1401 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1402 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001403
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001404maxsslrate <number>
1405 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1406 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1407 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1408 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1409 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1410 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1411 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1412 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1413 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1414 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1415
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001416maxzlibmem <number>
1417 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1418 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1419 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001420 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1421 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1422 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1423
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001424noepoll
1425 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1426 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001427 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428
1429nokqueue
1430 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1431 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1432 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1433
1434nopoll
1435 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1436 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001438 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001440nosplice
1441 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001442 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001443 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001444 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001445 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1446 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1447 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1448 "option splice-response".
1449
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001450nogetaddrinfo
1451 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1452 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1453
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001454noreuseport
1455 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1456 command line argument "-dR".
1457
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001458profiling.tasks { on | off }
1459 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1460 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1461 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1462 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1463 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1464 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1465 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1466 CLI.
1467
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001468spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001469 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1470 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1471 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1472 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1473 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1474 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001476ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001477 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001478 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001479 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1480 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1481 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1482 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1483 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1485 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001486 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1487 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1488 openssl configuration file uses:
1489 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1490
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001491ssl-mode-async
1492 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001493 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001494 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1495 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1496 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1497 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1498 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001499
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001500tune.buffers.limit <number>
1501 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1502 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1503 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1504 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1505 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001507 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1508 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1509 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1510 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1511 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1512 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1513 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1514 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1515 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1516
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001517tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1518 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1519 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1520 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1521 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1522
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001523tune.bufsize <number>
1524 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1525 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1526 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1527 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1528 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1529 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1530 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001531 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1532 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1533 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001534 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001535 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1536 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1537 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001538
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001539tune.chksize <number>
1540 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1541 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1542 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1543 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1544 checks whenever possible.
1545
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001546tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1547 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1548 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1549 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1550 this value. The default value is 1.
1551
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001552tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1553 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1554 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1555 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1556 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1557 change it.
1558
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001559tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1560 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001561 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1562 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001563 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1564 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1565 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1566 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1567 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1568
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001569tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1570 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1571 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1572 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1573 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1574 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1575 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1576 recommended not to change this value.
1577
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001578tune.http.cookielen <number>
1579 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1580 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1581 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1582 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1583 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1584 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1585 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1586 to change this value.
1587
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001588tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001589 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1590 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001591 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001592 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001593 configuration directives too.
1594 The default value is 1024.
1595
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001596tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1597 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1598 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1599 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1600 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1601 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1602 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001603 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1604 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1605 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001606
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001607tune.idletimer <timeout>
1608 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1609 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1610 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1611 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1612 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1613 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001614 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001615 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1616 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1617
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001618tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1619 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001620 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001621 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1622 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001623 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001624 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1625 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1626
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001627tune.lua.maxmem
1628 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1629 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1630 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1631 memory.
1632
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001633tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1634 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001635 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1636 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001637 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001638
1639tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1640 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1641 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1642 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1643 check servers.
1644
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001645tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1646 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1647 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1648 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001649 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001650
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001651tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001652 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1653 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1654 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1655 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1656 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1657 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1658 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1659 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1660 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1661 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001662
1663tune.maxpollevents <number>
1664 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1665 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1666 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1667 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1668 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1669
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001670tune.maxrewrite <number>
1671 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1672 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1673 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1674 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1675 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1676 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1677 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1678 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1679 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1680 bufsize.
1681
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001682tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1683 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1684 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1685 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1686 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1687 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1688 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1689 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1690 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1691 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1692 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1693 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1694 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1695 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1696 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1697 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1698 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1699 setting this parameter to 0.
1700
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001701tune.pipesize <number>
1702 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1703 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1704 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1705 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1706 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1707 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1708
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001709tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1710tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1711 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1712 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1713 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1714 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001715 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001716 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1717 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1718
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001719tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001720 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001721 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1722 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1723 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1724 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1725
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001726tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1727 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1728 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1729 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1730
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001731tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1732tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1733 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1734 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1735 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1736 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001737 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001738 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1739 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1740 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1741 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1742 notifying haproxy again.
1743
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001744tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001745 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1746 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1747 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001748 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001749 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001750 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001751 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1752 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1753 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001754 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1755 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001756
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001757tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001758 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001759 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1760 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1761 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1762 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1763 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1764
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001765tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1766 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001767 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001768 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1769 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1770 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1771 being used for too long.
1772
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001773tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1774 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1775 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1776 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1777 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1778 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1779 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1780 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1781 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1782 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1783 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001784 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001785 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001786
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001787tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1788 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1789 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1790 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1791 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1792 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1793 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1794 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001795 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1796 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001797
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001798tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1799 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1800 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1801 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1802 1000 entries.
1803
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001804tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1805 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1806 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1807 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1808
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001809tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001810tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001811tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1812tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1813tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001814 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1815 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1816 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1817 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1818 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1819 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1820 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1821 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001822
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001823 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1824 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1825 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1826 all available space is consumed.
1827 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1828 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1829 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001830
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001831tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1832 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001833 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001834 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001835 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001836 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1837
1838tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1839 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1840 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001841 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1842 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018443.3. Debugging
1845--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001846
1847debug
1848 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1849 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1850 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1851 system startup.
1852
1853quiet
1854 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1855 line argument "-q".
1856
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018583.4. Userlists
1859--------------
1860It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1861http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1862it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1863
1864userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001865 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001866 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1867
1868group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001869 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001870 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1871 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1872
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001873user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1874 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001875 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1876 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001877 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1878 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1879 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1880 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001881
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001882 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1883 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1884 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1885 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1886 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1887 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1888 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1889 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1890 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001891
1892 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001893 userlist L1
1894 group G1 users tiger,scott
1895 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001896
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001897 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1898 user scott insecure-password elgato
1899 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001900
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001901 userlist L2
1902 group G1
1903 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001905 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1906 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1907 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001908
1909 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001910
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001911
19123.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001913----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001914It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1915several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1916instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1917values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1918automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1919In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1920using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1921tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1922reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1923Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1924that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1925each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001926
1927peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001928 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001929 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1930
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001931bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1932 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1933 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1934
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001935disabled
1936 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1937 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1938 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1939
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001940default-bind [param*]
1941 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1942
1943default-server [param*]
1944 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1945
1946 Arguments:
1947 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1948 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1949 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1950 details.
1951
1952
1953 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
1954
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001955enable
1956 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1957
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001958peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001959 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1960 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1961 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1962 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1963 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1964 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1965
1966 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1967 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1968
1969 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1970 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1971 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1972 across all peers.
1973
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001974 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1975 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001976
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001977 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
1978 "server" keyword explanation below).
1979
1980server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
1981 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
1982 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
1983 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
1984 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
1985 of this "peers" section).
1986 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
1987
1988
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001989 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001990 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001991 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001992 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1993 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1994 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001995
1996 backend mybackend
1997 mode tcp
1998 balance roundrobin
1999 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2000 stick on src
2001
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002002 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2003 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002004
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002005 Example:
2006 peers mypeers
2007 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2008 default-server ssl verify none
2009 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2010 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002011
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020123.6. Mailers
2013------------
2014It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2015If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2016in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2017
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002018mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002019 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2020 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2021
2022mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2023 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2024
2025 Example:
2026 mailers mymailers
2027 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2028 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2029
2030 backend mybackend
2031 mode tcp
2032 balance roundrobin
2033
2034 email-alert mailers mymailers
2035 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2036 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2037
2038 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2039 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2040
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002041timeout mail <time>
2042 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2043 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2044 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2045 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2046
2047 Example:
2048 mailers mymailers
2049 timeout mail 20s
2050 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020524. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002053----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002055Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002056 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002057 - frontend <name>
2058 - backend <name>
2059 - listen <name>
2060
2061A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2062its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2063section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002064section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002065
2066A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2067connections.
2068
2069A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2070to forward incoming connections.
2071
2072A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2073parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2074
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002075All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2076'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2077case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2078
2079Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2080logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2081proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2082However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2083name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2084
2085Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2086and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002087bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002088protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2089modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2090arbitrary criteria.
2091
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002092In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2093a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002094the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002095
2096 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2097 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2098 between responses and new requests.
2099
2100 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2101 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2102 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002103 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2104 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002105
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002106 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2107 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2108 client-facing connection remains open.
2109
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002110 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2111 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002112
2113The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2114frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2115following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002116weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002117
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002118 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002119
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002120 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2121 ----+-----+-----+----
2122 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2123 ----+-----+-----+----
2124 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2125 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2126 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2127 ----+-----+-----+----
2128 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002130
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021324.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2133--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002135The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2136limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2137they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2138limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002139marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002140option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002141and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2142with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2143specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002144
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002145
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002146 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2147------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2148acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002149appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002150backlog X X X -
2151balance X - X X
2152bind - X X -
2153bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002154block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002155capture cookie - X X -
2156capture request header - X X -
2157capture response header - X X -
2158clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002159compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002160contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2161cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002162declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002163default-server X - X X
2164default_backend X X X -
2165description - X X X
2166disabled X X X X
2167dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002168email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002169email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002170email-alert mailers X X X X
2171email-alert myhostname X X X X
2172email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002173enabled X X X X
2174errorfile X X X X
2175errorloc X X X X
2176errorloc302 X X X X
2177-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2178errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002179force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002180filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002181fullconn X - X X
2182grace X X X X
2183hash-type X - X X
2184http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002185http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002186http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002187http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002188http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002189http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002190http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002191id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002192ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002193load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002194log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002195log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002196log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002197log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002198max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002199maxconn X X X -
2200mode X X X X
2201monitor fail - X X -
2202monitor-net X X X -
2203monitor-uri X X X -
2204option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2205option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2206option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2207option allbackups (*) X - X X
2208option checkcache (*) X - X X
2209option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2210option contstats (*) X X X -
2211option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2212option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002213option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002214-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2215option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002216option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002217option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002218option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002219option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002220option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002221option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002222option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002223option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002224option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002225option httpchk X - X X
2226option httpclose (*) X X X X
2227option httplog X X X X
2228option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002229option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002230option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002231option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002232option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2233option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2234option logasap (*) X X X -
2235option mysql-check X - X X
2236option nolinger (*) X X X X
2237option originalto X X X X
2238option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002239option pgsql-check X - X X
2240option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002241option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002242option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002243option smtpchk X - X X
2244option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2245option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2246option splice-request (*) X X X X
2247option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002248option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002249option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2250option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2251-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002252option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002253option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2254option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2255option tcpka X X X X
2256option tcplog X X X X
2257option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002258external-check command X - X X
2259external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002260persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2261rate-limit sessions X X X -
2262redirect - X X X
2263redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2264redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2265reqadd - X X X
2266reqallow - X X X
2267reqdel - X X X
2268reqdeny - X X X
2269reqiallow - X X X
2270reqidel - X X X
2271reqideny - X X X
2272reqipass - X X X
2273reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002274reqitarpit - X X X
2275reqpass - X X X
2276reqrep - X X X
2277-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002278reqtarpit - X X X
2279retries X - X X
2280rspadd - X X X
2281rspdel - X X X
2282rspdeny - X X X
2283rspidel - X X X
2284rspideny - X X X
2285rspirep - X X X
2286rsprep - X X X
2287server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002288server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002289server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002290source X - X X
2291srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002292stats admin - X X X
2293stats auth X X X X
2294stats enable X X X X
2295stats hide-version X X X X
2296stats http-request - X X X
2297stats realm X X X X
2298stats refresh X X X X
2299stats scope X X X X
2300stats show-desc X X X X
2301stats show-legends X X X X
2302stats show-node X X X X
2303stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002304-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2305stick match - - X X
2306stick on - - X X
2307stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002308stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002309stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002310tcp-check connect - - X X
2311tcp-check expect - - X X
2312tcp-check send - - X X
2313tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002314tcp-request connection - X X -
2315tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002316tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002317tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002318tcp-response content - - X X
2319tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002320timeout check X - X X
2321timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002322timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002323timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2324timeout connect X - X X
2325timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2326timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2327timeout http-request X X X X
2328timeout queue X - X X
2329timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002330timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002331timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2332timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002333timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002334transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002335unique-id-format X X X -
2336unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002337use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002338use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002339------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2340 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023434.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2344---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345
2346This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2347
2348
2349acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2350 Declare or complete an access list.
2351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2352 no | yes | yes | yes
2353 Example:
2354 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2355 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2356 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002358 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002359
2360
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002361appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2362 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2365 no | no | yes | yes
2366 Arguments :
2367 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2368 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2369
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002370 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002371 checked in each cookie value.
2372
2373 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2374 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2375 milliseconds.
2376
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002377 request-learn
2378 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2379 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2380 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2381 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2382 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2383 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2384
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002385 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2386 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2387 data following this prefix.
2388
2389 Example :
2390 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2391
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002392 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2393 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002394
2395 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2396 2 modes are currently supported :
2397 - path-parameters :
2398 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2399 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2400 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2401 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2402 - query-string :
2403 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2404 query string.
2405
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002406 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2407 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2408 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002409
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002410 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2411 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002412
2413
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002414backlog <conns>
2415 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2417 yes | yes | yes | no
2418 Arguments :
2419 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2420 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002421 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002422
2423 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2424 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2425 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2426 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2427 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2428 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2429 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2430 backlog parameter.
2431
2432 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2433 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2434 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2435
2436 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2437
2438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002439balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002440balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002441 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2443 yes | no | yes | yes
2444 Arguments :
2445 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2446 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2447 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2448 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2449
2450 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2451 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2452 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2453 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002454 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002455 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002456 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2457 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2458 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2459 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2460 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2461 it, so that you don't worry.
2462
2463 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2464 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2465 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2466 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2467 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2468 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2469 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2470 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002471
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002472 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2473 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2474 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2475 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2476 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2477 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2478 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2479 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2480
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002481 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002482 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002483 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2484 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002485 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002486 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2487 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2488 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2489 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2490 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002491 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2492 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2493 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2494 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2495 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2496 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002498 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2499 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2500 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2501 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2502 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2503 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2504 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2505 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002506 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002507 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002508 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2509 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2510 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002512 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2513 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2514 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2515 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2516 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2517 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2518 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2519 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2520 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2521 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2522 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2523 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002524
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002525 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002526 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2527 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2528 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2529 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2530 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2531 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2532 URIs start with a leading "/".
2533
2534 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2535 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2536 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2537 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2538
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002539 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002540 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2541
2542 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002543 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2544 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002545 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2546 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2547 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2548 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002549 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002550 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2551 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002552
2553 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2554 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2555 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2556 server will receive the request.
2557
2558 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2559 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2560 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2561 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2562 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002563 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2564 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2565 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002566
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002567 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2568 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2569 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2570 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2571 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002573 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002574 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2575 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2576 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2577
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002578 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2579 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2580 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2581
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002582 random
2583 random(<draws>)
2584 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002585 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2586 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2587 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2588 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002589 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2590 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2591 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2592 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2593 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2594 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2595 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2596 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2597 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2598 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2599 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2600 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2601 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2602 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2603 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2604 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2605 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2606 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2607 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2608 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002609
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002610 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002611 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002612 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2613 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2614 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2615 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2616 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2617 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002618 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002619 used instead.
2620
2621 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2622 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2623 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2624 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2625
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002626 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2627 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2628 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2629
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002630 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002632 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002633 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2634 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002635
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002636 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2637 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2638 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002639
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002640 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2641 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2642 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2643 NTLM relies on.
2644
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002645 Examples :
2646 balance roundrobin
2647 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002648 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002649 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2650 balance hdr(host)
2651 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002652
2653 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2654 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002656 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002657 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2658 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2659 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2660 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2661
2662 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2663 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2664 defaults to 16 kB.
2665
2666 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2667 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2668
2669 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2670 Round Robin.
2671
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002672 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002673 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2674 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2675 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2676
2677 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2678
2679 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002680 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002681 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2682 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2683 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002684
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002685 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686
2687
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002688bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2689bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002690 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2692 no | yes | yes | no
2693 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002694 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2695 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2696 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2697 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002698 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002699 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2700 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2701 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2702 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2703 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2704 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2705 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002706 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2707 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2708 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2709 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2710 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2711 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2712 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002713 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2714 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2715 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002716 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2717 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2718 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2719 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002720 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2721 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2722 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002723
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002724 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2725 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002726 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2727 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2728 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002729 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2730 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2731 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2732 the range.
2733
2734 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2735 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2736 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2737 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2738 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2739 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2740 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002741 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002742 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002743
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002744 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002745 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002746 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2747 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2748 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2749 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2750 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2751 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2752
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002753 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2754 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2755 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2756 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2759 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2760 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2761 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2762 in a frontend.
2763
2764 Example :
2765 listen http_proxy
2766 bind :80,:443
2767 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002768 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002769
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002770 listen http_https_proxy
2771 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002772 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002773
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002774 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2775 bind ipv6@:80
2776 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2777 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2778
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002779 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002780 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002781
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002782 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2783 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2784 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2785 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2786 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2787
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002788 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002789 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790
2791
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002792bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002793 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2795 yes | yes | yes | yes
2796 Arguments :
2797 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2798 may be used to override a default value.
2799
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002800 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002801 option may be combined with other numbers.
2802
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002803 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002804 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2805 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2806 missing from all processes.
2807
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002808 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002809 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002810 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2811 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2812 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2813 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2814 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002815 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002816
2817 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2818 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2819 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2820 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2821 and 'even' instances.
2822
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002823 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2824 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2825 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2826 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002827
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002828 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2829 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2830
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002831 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2832 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2833 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2834
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002835 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2836 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2837
2838 Example :
2839 listen app_ip1
2840 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002841 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002842
2843 listen app_ip2
2844 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002845 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002846
2847 listen management
2848 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002849 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002850
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002851 listen management
2852 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2853 bind-process 1-4
2854
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002855 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002856
2857
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002858block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2861 no | yes | yes | yes
2862
2863 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2864 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002865 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002866 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002868 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2869 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2870 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002871
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002872 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2873 "http-request deny" instead.
2874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875 Example:
2876 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2877 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2878 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002879 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2880 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2881 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002883 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2884 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2885 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886
2887capture cookie <name> len <length>
2888 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2890 no | yes | yes | no
2891 Arguments :
2892 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2893 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2894 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2895 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002896 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002897
2898 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2899 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2900 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2901 right if it exceeds <length>.
2902
2903 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2904 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2905 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2906 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2907
2908 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2909 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2910 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2911
2912 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2913 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2914 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002915 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2916 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2917 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002918
2919 Example:
2920 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2921
2922 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002923 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002924
2925
2926capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002927 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2929 no | yes | yes | no
2930 Arguments :
2931 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002932 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002933 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2934 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2935 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2936
2937 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2938 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2939 it exceeds <length>.
2940
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002941 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002942 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2943 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002944 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2945 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2946 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2947 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002948 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002949 environments to find where the request came from.
2950
2951 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2952 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2953 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2954 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002955
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002956 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2957 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2958 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2959 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2960 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961
2962 Example:
2963 capture request header Host len 15
2964 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002965 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002967 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002968 about logging.
2969
2970
2971capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002972 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2974 no | yes | yes | no
2975 Arguments :
2976 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002977 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002978 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2979 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2980 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2981
2982 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2983 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2984 it exceeds <length>.
2985
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002986 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002987 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2988 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2989 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002990 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2991 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2992 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2993 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002994
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002995 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2996 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2997 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2998 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2999 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003000
3001 Example:
3002 capture response header Content-length len 9
3003 capture response header Location len 15
3004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003005 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003006 about logging.
3007
3008
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003009clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003010 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3012 yes | yes | yes | no
3013 Arguments :
3014 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3015 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3016 as explained at the top of this document.
3017
3018 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3019 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3020 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3021 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3022 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3023 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3024 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3025 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003026 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003027 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003028 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003029
3030 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3031 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3032 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3033 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3034 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3035 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3036
3037 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3038 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3039
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003040 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3041 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003042
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003043compression algo <algorithm> ...
3044compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003045compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003046 Enable HTTP compression.
3047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3048 yes | yes | yes | yes
3049 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003050 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3051 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3052 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3053
3054 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003055 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3056 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3057 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003058
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003059 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003060 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003061
3062 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3063 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3064 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3065 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3066 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003067 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003068
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003069 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3070 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3071 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3072 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3073 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3074 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3075 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003076 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003077
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003078 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003079 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003080 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3081 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3082 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3083 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3084 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003085
3086 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3087 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3088 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3089 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3090 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003091 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3092 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3093 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3094 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3095 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003096 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3097 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003098
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003099 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003100 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3101 "Accept-Encoding" header
3102 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01003103 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01003104 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
3105 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003106 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3107 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3108 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3109 "multipart"
3110 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3111 header
3112 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3113 and later
3114 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3115 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003116
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003117 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
3118 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003119
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003120 Examples :
3121 compression algo gzip
3122 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003123
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003124
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003125contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003126 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3128 yes | no | yes | yes
3129 Arguments :
3130 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3131 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3132 as explained at the top of this document.
3133
3134 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003135 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003136 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003137 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3139 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3140 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3141
3142 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3143 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3144 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3145 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3146 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3147 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3148
3149 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3150 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3151 instead.
3152
3153 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3154 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3155
3156
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003157cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003158 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3159 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003160 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3163 yes | no | yes | yes
3164 Arguments :
3165 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3166 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3167 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3168 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3169 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3170 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003171 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003172 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3173 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3174
3175 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3176 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3177 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3178 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3179 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3180 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003181 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3182 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003183 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003184 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3185 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003186
3187 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003188 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003189
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003190 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003191 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3192 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003193 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003194 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3195 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3196 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3197 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3198 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3199 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3200 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003201
3202 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3203 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3204 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3205 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3206 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3207 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3208 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3209 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3210 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003211 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003212 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3213 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3214 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003215
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003216 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3217 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3218 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003219 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3220 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3221 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3222 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003223 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3224 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3225 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003226
3227 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3228 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3229 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3230 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3231 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3232 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3233 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3234 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3235 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3236
3237 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3238 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3239 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3240 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3241 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3242 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3243 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3244 persistence cookie in the cache.
3245 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3246
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003247 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3248 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3249 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3250 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3251 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003252 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003253 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3254 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3255 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3256 they logout.
3257
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003258 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3259 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3260 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3261 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3262
3263 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3264 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3265 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3266 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3267 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3268 this attribute.
3269
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003270 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003271 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003272 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3273 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3274 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3275 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3276 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3277 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003278
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003279 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3280 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3281 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3282 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3283 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3284 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3285 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3286 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003287 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003288 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3289 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3290 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3291 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3292 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3293 the site.
3294
3295 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3296 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3297 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3298 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3299 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3300 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3301 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3302 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3303 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3304 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3305 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3306 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3307 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003308 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003309 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3310 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3311
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003312 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3313 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3314 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3315 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3316 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3317 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3318
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003319 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3320 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3321 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3322 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003323
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003324 Examples :
3325 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3326 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3327 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003328 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003329
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003330 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003331
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003332
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003333declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3334 Declares a capture slot.
3335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3336 no | yes | yes | no
3337 Arguments:
3338 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3339
3340 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3341 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3342 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3343 for use in the response.
3344
3345 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003346 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003347 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3348
3349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003350default-server [param*]
3351 Change default options for a server in a backend
3352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3353 yes | no | yes | yes
3354 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003355 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3356 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3357 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3358 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003359
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003360 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003361 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3362
3363 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366default_backend <backend>
3367 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3369 yes | yes | yes | no
3370 Arguments :
3371 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3372
3373 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3374 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3375 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3376 will catch all undetermined requests.
3377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003378 Example :
3379
3380 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3381 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3382 default_backend dynamic
3383
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003384 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003385
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003386
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003387description <string>
3388 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3390 no | yes | yes | yes
3391 Arguments : string
3392
3393 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3394 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3395 it describes.
3396 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3397
3398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003399disabled
3400 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3402 yes | yes | yes | yes
3403 Arguments : none
3404
3405 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3406 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3407 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3408 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3409 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3410 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3411 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3412
3413 See also : "enabled"
3414
3415
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003416dispatch <address>:<port>
3417 Set a default server address
3418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3419 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003420 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003421
3422 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3423 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3424 during start-up.
3425
3426 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3427 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3428 possible with normal servers.
3429
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003430 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003431 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3432 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3433 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3434 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3435
3436 See also : "server"
3437
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003438
3439dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3440 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3442 yes | no | yes | yes
3443 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3444
3445 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003446 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003447 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3448 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003449 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003450 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003451
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003452enabled
3453 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3455 yes | yes | yes | yes
3456 Arguments : none
3457
3458 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3459 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3460
3461 See also : "disabled"
3462
3463
3464errorfile <code> <file>
3465 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 yes | yes | yes | yes
3468 Arguments :
3469 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003470 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3471 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472
3473 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003474 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003475 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003476 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3477 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003478
3479 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3480 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3481 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3482
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003483 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3484
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3486 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3487 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3488 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3489
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003490 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3491 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003492 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003493 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3494 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3495 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3496
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003497 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3498 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3499 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003500 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003501 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3502
3503 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3504
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003505 Example :
3506 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003507 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003508 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3509 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003511
3512errorloc <code> <url>
3513errorloc302 <code> <url>
3514 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3516 yes | yes | yes | yes
3517 Arguments :
3518 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003519 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3520 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003521
3522 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3523 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3524 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3525 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003526 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003527
3528 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3529 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3530 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3531
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003532 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3533
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003534 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3535 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3536 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3537 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003538 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003539 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3540 request.
3541
3542 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3543
3544
3545errorloc303 <code> <url>
3546 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3548 yes | yes | yes | yes
3549 Arguments :
3550 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003551 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3552 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003553
3554 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3555 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3556 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3557 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003558 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003559
3560 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3561 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3562 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3563
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003564 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3565
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003566 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3567 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3568 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3569 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003570 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003571
3572 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3573
3574
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003575email-alert from <emailaddr>
3576 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003577 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003578 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3579 yes | yes | yes | yes
3580
3581 Arguments :
3582
3583 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3584
3585 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3586 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3587
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003588 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003589 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3590 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003591
3592
3593email-alert level <level>
3594 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3595 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3597 yes | yes | yes | yes
3598
3599 Arguments :
3600
3601 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3602 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3603 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3604
3605 By default level is alert
3606
3607 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3608 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3609 for the proxy.
3610
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003611 Alerts are sent when :
3612
3613 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3614 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3615 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3616 is notice or lower
3617 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3618 and a health check status update occurs
3619
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003620 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3621 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003622 section 3.6 about mailers.
3623
3624
3625email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3626 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3628 yes | yes | yes | yes
3629
3630 Arguments :
3631
3632 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3633
3634 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3635 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3636
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003637 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3638 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003639
3640
3641email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3642 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3643 mailers.
3644 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3645 yes | yes | yes | yes
3646
3647 Arguments :
3648
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003649 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003650
3651 By default the systems hostname is used.
3652
3653 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3654 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3655 for the proxy.
3656
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003657 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3658 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003659
3660
3661email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003662 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003663 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3665 yes | yes | yes | yes
3666
3667 Arguments :
3668
3669 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3670
3671 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3672 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3673
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003674 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003675 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3676
3677
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003678force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3679 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003681 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003682
3683 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3684 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3685 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3686 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3687 marked down for maintenance operations.
3688
3689 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3690 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3691 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3692 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3693 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3694 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3695 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3696 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3697 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3698
3699 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3700 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3701 is used.
3702
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003703 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003704 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003705
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003706
3707filter <name> [param*]
3708 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3710 no | yes | yes | yes
3711 Arguments :
3712 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3713 referenced in section 9.
3714
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003715 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003716 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003717 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3718 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003719
3720 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3721 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3722
3723 Example:
3724 listen
3725 bind *:80
3726
3727 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3728 filter compression
3729 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3730
3731 compression algo gzip
3732 compression offload
3733
3734 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3735
3736 See also : section 9.
3737
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003738
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003739fullconn <conns>
3740 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3742 yes | no | yes | yes
3743 Arguments :
3744 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3745 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3746
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003747 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003748 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003749 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003750 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3751 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3752 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3753 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3754 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003755 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003756
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003757 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3758 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003759 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3760 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3761 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003762
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003763 Example :
3764 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3765 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3766 # connections.
3767 backend dynamic
3768 fullconn 10000
3769 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3770 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3771
3772 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3773
3774
3775grace <time>
3776 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003778 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003779 Arguments :
3780 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3781 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3782 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3783
3784 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3785 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003786 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003787 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3788
3789 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3790 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3791 simplify it.
3792
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003793
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003794hash-balance-factor <factor>
3795 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3797 yes | no | no | yes
3798 Arguments :
3799 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3800 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3801 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3802
3803 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3804 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3805 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3806 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3807 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3808 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3809 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3810
3811 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3812 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3813 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3814 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3815 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3816
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003817 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3818 consistent hashing mechanism.
3819
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003820 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3821
3822
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003823hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003824 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3826 yes | no | yes | yes
3827 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003828 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3829 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003830
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003831 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3832 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3833 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3834 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3835 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3836 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3837 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3838 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3839 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3840 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003841
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003842 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3843 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3844 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3845 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3846 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3847 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3848 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3849 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3850 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3851 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3852 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3853 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3854 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003855 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3856 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003857
3858 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3859
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003860 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003861 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3862 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3863 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003864 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3865 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3866 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003867
3868 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3869 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003870 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3871 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3872 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3873 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3874
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003875 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3876 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3877 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3878 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3879 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3880 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3881 parameter.
3882
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003883 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3884 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3885 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3886 used on strings.
3887
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003888 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3889
3890 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3891 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3892 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3893 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3894 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3895 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3896 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3897 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3898 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3899 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3900 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3901 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003902
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003903 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3904 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3905 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003906
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003907 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003908
3909
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003910http-check disable-on-404
3911 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003913 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003914 Arguments : none
3915
3916 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3917 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3918 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3919 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3920 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3921 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3922 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3923 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003924 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3925 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3926 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3927
3928 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3929
3930
3931http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003932 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003934 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003935 Arguments :
3936 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3937 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003938 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003939 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3940 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3941 details on the supported keywords.
3942
3943 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3944 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3945 with the usual backslash ('\').
3946
3947 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3948 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3949 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3950 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3951 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3952
3953 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003954 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003955 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3956 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3957 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3958
3959 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003960 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003961 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3962 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3963 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3964 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3965
3966 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003967 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003968 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3969 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3970 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3971 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3972 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003973 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003974 trace).
3975
3976 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003977 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003978 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3979 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3980 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3981 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3982 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003983 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003984
3985 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3986 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3987 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3988 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3989 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3990 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3991 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3992 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3993
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003994 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3995 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3996 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3997
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003998 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3999 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4000
4001 Examples :
4002 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004003 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004004
4005 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004006 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004007
4008 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004009 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004010
4011 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004012 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004013
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004014 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004015
4016
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004017http-check send-state
4018 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4020 yes | no | yes | yes
4021 Arguments : none
4022
4023 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4024 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4025 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4026 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4027 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4028
4029 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4030 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4031 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4032 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4033 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004034 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4035 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4036 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4037
4038 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4039 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4040 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4041
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004042 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4043 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4044 checked in multiple backends.
4045
4046 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4047 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4048
4049 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4050 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4051 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4052 one fails.
4053
4054 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4055 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4056 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4057
4058 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4059 server's queue.
4060
4061 Example of a header received by the application server :
4062 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4063 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4064
4065 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004067
4068http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004069 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4070
4071 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4072 no | yes | yes | yes
4073
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004074 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4075 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4076 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4077 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4078 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004080 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4081 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004083 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004085 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4086 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4087 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4088 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004090 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4091 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4092 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4093 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004094
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004095 Example:
4096 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4097 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4098 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004100 http-request allow if nagios
4101 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4102 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4103 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004105 Example:
4106 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4107 acl add path /addacl
4108 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004110 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004112 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4113 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004115 Example:
4116 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4117 acl setmap path /setmap
4118 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004120 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004122 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4123 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004125 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4126 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004127
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004128http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004130 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4131 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4132 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4133 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4134 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4135 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4136 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4137 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004139http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004141 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4142 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4143 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4144 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4145 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4146 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4147 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4148 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004150http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004152 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4153 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004154
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004156http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004158 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4159 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4160 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4161 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4162 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004163
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004164 Example:
4165 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4166 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004167
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004168http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004170 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004172http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4173 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004174
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004175 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4176 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4177 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4178 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4179 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4180 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4181 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4182 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4183 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004185 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4186 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4187 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4188 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4189 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4190 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004192http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004193
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004194 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4195 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4196 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4197 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4198 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4199 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004200
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004201http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004203 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004206
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004207 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4208 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4209 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4210 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4211 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4212 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004213
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004214http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004216 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4217 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4218 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4219 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4220 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004221
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004222http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4223
4224 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4225 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4226 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4227 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004228 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4229 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004230
4231 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004234
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004235 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4236 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4237 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4238 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4239 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004241http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004243 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4244 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4245 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4246 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4249 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004251 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4252 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4253 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4254 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4255 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4256 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4257 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4258 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004259
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004260 Example:
4261 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004263 # applied to:
4264 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004266 # outputs:
4267 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004269 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004271http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4272 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004273
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004274 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4275 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4276 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4277 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279 Example:
4280 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282 # applied to:
4283 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004285 # outputs:
4286 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004288http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4289http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004291 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4292 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4293 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004295http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004296
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004297 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4298 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4299 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004302
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004303 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4304 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4305 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4306 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4307 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 Arguments:
4310 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4311 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004313 Example:
4314 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4315 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004317 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4318 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004319
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004320http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4323 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4324 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 Arguments:
4327 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4328 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330 Example:
4331 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4332 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004334 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4335 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4336 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4341 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4342 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4343 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4344 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004346 Example:
4347 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4348 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4349 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4350 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4351 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4352 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4353 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4354 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4355 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004359 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4360 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4361 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4362 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4363 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4366 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004368 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4369 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4370 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4371 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4372 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4373 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4374 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4375 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4376 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004380 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4381 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4382 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4383 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4384 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4385 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4386 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004388http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004390 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4391 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4392 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4397 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4398 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4399 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4400 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4401 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4402 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4403 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004405http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4408 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4409 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4410 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4411 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4412 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004414 Example :
4415 # prepend the host name before the path
4416 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4421 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4422 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4423 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4424 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004426http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004428 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4429 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4430 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4431 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4432 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4433 values have higher priority.
4434 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4435 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4436 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4437 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4438 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004440http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004441
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004442 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4443 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4444 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4445 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4446 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4447 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4448 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004450 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004451
4452 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004453 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4454 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004456http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4457 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4458 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4459 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4460 privacy.
4461
4462 Arguments :
4463 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4464 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004465
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004466 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004467 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4468 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4469
4470 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4471 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4472
4473http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4474
4475 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4476 expression.
4477
4478 Arguments:
4479 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4480 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004481
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004482 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004483 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4484 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4485
4486 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4487 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4488 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4489
4490http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4491
4492 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4493 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4494 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4495 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4496 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4497 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4498 information from the request.
4499
4500 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4501
4502http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4503
4504 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4505 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4506 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4507 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4508 path and the query string.
4509 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4510
4511http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4512
4513 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4514 inline.
4515
4516 Arguments:
4517 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4518 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4519 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4520 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4521 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4522 (request and response)
4523 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4524 processing
4525 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4526 processing
4527 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4528 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4529 and '_'.
4530
4531 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4532 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004533
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004534 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004535 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004537http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4538 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004540 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4541 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4542 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4543 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4544 agent name must be used.
4545
4546 Arguments:
4547 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4548
4549 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4550 configuration.
4551
4552http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4553
4554 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4555 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4556 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4557 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4558 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4559 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4560 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4561 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4562 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4563 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4564 action.
4565 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4566 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4567 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4568 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4569 you fully understand how it works.
4570
4571http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4572
4573 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4574 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4575 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4576 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4577 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4578 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4579 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4580 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4581 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4582 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4583 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4584 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4585 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4586
4587http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4588http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4589http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4590
4591 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4592 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4593 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4594 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4595 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4596 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4597 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4598 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4599 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4600 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4601 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4602 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4603
4604 Arguments :
4605 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4606 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4607 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4608 select which table entry to update the counters.
4609
4610 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4611 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4612 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4613 that table until the session ends.
4614
4615 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4616 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4617 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4618 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4619 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4620 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4621 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4622 useful information.
4623
4624 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4625 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4626 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4627 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4628 checks that make use of it.
4629
4630http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4631
4632 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004633
4634 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004635 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004639 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4640 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4641 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004642
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004643
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004644http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004645 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4646
4647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4648 no | yes | yes | yes
4649
4650 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4651 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4652 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4653 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4654 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4655 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4656
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004657 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4658 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004659
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004660 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004661
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004662 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4663 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4664 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4665 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004666
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004667 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4668 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4669 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4670 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004671
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004672 Example:
4673 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004674
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004675 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004676
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004677 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4678 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004679
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004680 Example:
4681 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004682
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004683 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004684
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004685 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4686 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004688 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4689 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004690
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004691http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004692
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004693 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4694 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4695 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4696 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4697 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4698 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4699 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4700 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004701
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004702http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004703
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004704 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4705 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4706 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4707 example, or to pass some internal information.
4708 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4709 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4710 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004711
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004712http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004713
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004714 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4715 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004716
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004717http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004718
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004719 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004720
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004721http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004722
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004723 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4724 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4725 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4726 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4727 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4728 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4729 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004730
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004731 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4732 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4733 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4734 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4735 keyword.
4736 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4737 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004738
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004739http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004740
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004741 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4742 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4743 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4744 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4745 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4746 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004747
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004748http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004749
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004750 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004752http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004754 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4755 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4756 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4757 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4758 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4759 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004760
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004761http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004762
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004763 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4764 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004765
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004766http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004767
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004768 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4769 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4770 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4771 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4772 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4773 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004774
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004775http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4776 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004777
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004778 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4779 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4780 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4781 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4782 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4783 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4784 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4785 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004787 Example:
4788 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004789
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004790 # applied to:
4791 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004792
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004793 # outputs:
4794 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004795
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004796 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004797
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004798http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4799 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004800
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004801 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4802 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4803 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4804 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004805
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004806 Example:
4807 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004808
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004809 # applied to:
4810 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004811
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004812 # outputs:
4813 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004815http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4816http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004817
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004818 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4819 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4820 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004821
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004822http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004823
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004824 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4825 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4826 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004827
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004828http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004830 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4831 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4832 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4833 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4834 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004836 Arguments:
4837 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004838
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004839 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4840 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004841
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004842http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004843
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004844 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4845 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4846 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004847
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004848http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4849
4850 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4851 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4852 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4853 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4854 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4855
4856http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4857
4858 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4859 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4860 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4861 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4862 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4863 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4864 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4865 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4866 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4867
4868http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4869
4870 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4871 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4872 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4873 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4874 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4875 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4876 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4877
4878http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4879
4880 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4881 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4882 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4883 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4884 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4885 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4886 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4887 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4888
4889http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4890 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4891
4892 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4893 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4894 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4895 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004896
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004897 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004898 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4899 http-response set-status 431
4900 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4901 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004903http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004904
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004905 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4906 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4907 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4908 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4909 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4910 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4911 based on some information from the request.
4912
4913 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4914
4915http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4916
4917 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4918 inline.
4919
4920 Arguments:
4921 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4922 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4923 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4924 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4925 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4926 (request and response)
4927 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4928 processing
4929 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4930 processing
4931 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4932 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4933 and '_'.
4934
4935 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4936 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004937
4938 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004939 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004941http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004942
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004943 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4944 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4945 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4946 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4947 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4948 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4949 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4950 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4951 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4952 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4953 action.
4954 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4955 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4956 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4957 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4958 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004960http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4961http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4962http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004964 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4965 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4966 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4967 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4968 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4969 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4970
4971http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4972
4973 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4974 about <var-name>.
4975
4976 Example:
4977 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4978
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004979
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004980http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4981 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4982
4983 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4984 yes | no | yes | yes
4985
4986 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004987 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
4988 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
4989 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004990
4991 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4992
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004993 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
4994 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
4995 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
4996 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
4997 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
4998 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
4999 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5000 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5001 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5002 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005003
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005004 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5005 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5006 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5007 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5008 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5009 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5010 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5011 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005012
5013 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5014 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5015 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5016 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5017 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5018 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5019 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5020 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5021 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5022 downsides of rare connection failures.
5023
5024 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5025 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5026 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5027 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5028 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5029 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005030 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005031 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5032 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5033 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5034 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5035 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5036
5037 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005038 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5039 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5040 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005041
5042 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005043 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005044
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005045 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5046 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005047
5048 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5049 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5050 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5051
5052 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5053 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5054 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5055
5056 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5057
5058
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005059http-send-name-header [<header>]
5060 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5061
5062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5063 yes | no | yes | yes
5064
5065 Arguments :
5066
5067 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5068
5069 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005070 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005071 is added with the header string proved.
5072
5073 See also : "server"
5074
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005075id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005076 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5078 no | yes | yes | yes
5079 Arguments : none
5080
5081 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5082 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5083 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005084
5085
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005086ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5087 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5088 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005089 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005090
5091 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5092 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5093 and running).
5094
5095 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5096 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5097 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005098 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005099 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5100
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005101 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5102 "unless" condition is met.
5103
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005104 Example:
5105 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5106 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5107 ignore-persist if url_static
5108
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005109 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5110
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005111load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5112 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5113 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5114 yes | no | yes | yes
5115
5116 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5117 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5118 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005119 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005120 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5121 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5122 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5123 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5124
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005125 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005126 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005127 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005128
5129 Arguments:
5130 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5131 named "server-state-file".
5132
5133 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5134 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5135 name is used as a file name.
5136
5137 none don't load any stat for this backend
5138
5139 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005140 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5141 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5142 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005143 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005144 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005145
5146 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5147 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5148
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005149 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005150
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005151 global
5152 stats socket /tmp/socket
5153 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005154
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005155 defaults
5156 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005157
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005158 backend bk
5159 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5160 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005161
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005162
5163 Then one can run :
5164
5165 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5166
5167 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5168
5169 1
5170 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5171 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5172 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5173
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005174 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005175
5176 global
5177 stats socket /tmp/socket
5178 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5179
5180 defaults
5181 load-server-state-from-file local
5182
5183 backend bk
5184 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5185 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5186
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005187
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005188 Then one can run :
5189
5190 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5191
5192 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5193
5194 1
5195 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5196 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5197 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5198
5199 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5200 "show servers state"
5201
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005202
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005203log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005204log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005205no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005206 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5208 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005209
5210 Prefix :
5211 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5212 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5213 prefix does not allow arguments.
5214
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005215 Arguments :
5216 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5217 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5218 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5219 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5220 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5221 parameter.
5222
5223 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5224 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5225
5226 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5227 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5228 standard syslog port).
5229
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005230 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5231 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5232 standard syslog port).
5233
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005234 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5235 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5236 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005237 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005238
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005239 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5240 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5241 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5242 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5243 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5244 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5245 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5246 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5247 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5248 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5249 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5250 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5251 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5252 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5253 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5254 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005255 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5256 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005257
5258 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5259 and "fd@2", see above.
5260
5261 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5262 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005263
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005264 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5265 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5266 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5267 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5268 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5269 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5270 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5271 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5272 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5273 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005274 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005275
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005276 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5277 one of the following :
5278
5279 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5280 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5281
5282 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5283 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5284
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005285 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5286 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5287 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5288 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5289 systemd logger consumes.
5290
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005291 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5292 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5293 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5294 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5295
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005296 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5297
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005298 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5299 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5300 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5301
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005302 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5303 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5304 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5305 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005306
5307 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5308 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5309 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005310 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5311 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5312 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5313 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5314 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005315
5316 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5317
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005318 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5319 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5320 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005321
5322 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5323 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5324 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5325 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5326
5327 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5328 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005329
5330 Example :
5331 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005332 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5333 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5334 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005335 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5336 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005337 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005338
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005339
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005340log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005341 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5342 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5343 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005344
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005345 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5346 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5347 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5348 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5349 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005350
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005351 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5352 "option httplog" directives.
5353
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005354log-format-sd <string>
5355 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5356 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5357 yes | yes | yes | no
5358
5359 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5360 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5361 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5362 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5363 which covers the log format string in depth.
5364
5365 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5366 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5367
5368 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5369 log format to "rfc5424".
5370
5371 Example :
5372 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5373
5374
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005375log-tag <string>
5376 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5377 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5378 yes | yes | yes | yes
5379
5380 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5381 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5382 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5383 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5384 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5385 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5386 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5387 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5388 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005389
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005390max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5391 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5392 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5393 yes | no | yes | yes
5394
5395 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5396 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5397 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5398 servers.
5399
5400 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5401 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5402 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5403 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5404 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005405 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005406 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5407 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5408 picking a different server.
5409
5410 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5411 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5412 even if they have to be queued.
5413
5414 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5415 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5416
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005417max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5418 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5419 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5420 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005421
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005422maxconn <conns>
5423 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5425 yes | yes | yes | no
5426 Arguments :
5427 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5428 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5429 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5430 closes.
5431
5432 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5433 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5434 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5435 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005436 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5437 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5438 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5439 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005440
5441 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5442 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5443 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5444
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005445 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5446
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005447 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5448
5449
5450mode { tcp|http|health }
5451 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5453 yes | yes | yes | yes
5454 Arguments :
5455 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5456 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5457 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5458 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5459
5460 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5461 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5462 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5463 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5464 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5465
5466 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005467 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5468 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5469 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5470 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5471 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5472 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5473 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005474
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005475 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5476 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5477 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005478
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005479 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005480 defaults http_instances
5481 mode http
5482
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005483 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005484
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005485
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005486monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005487 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5489 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005490 Arguments :
5491 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5492 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005493 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005494 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5495 backend and its backup.
5496
5497 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5498 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5499 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5500 servers in a list of backends.
5501
5502 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5503 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5504 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5505 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5506 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5507 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5508 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005509 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5510 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005511
5512 Example:
5513 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005514 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005515 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5516 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5517 monitor-uri /site_alive
5518 monitor fail if site_dead
5519
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005520 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005521
5522
5523monitor-net <source>
5524 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5526 yes | yes | yes | no
5527 Arguments :
5528 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5529 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5530 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5531 followed by a mask.
5532
5533 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5534 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005535 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005536 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5537
5538 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5539 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5540 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5541 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005542 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5543 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5544 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005545
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005546 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5547 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5548 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5549 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5550 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5551 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005552
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005553 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5554 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005555
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005556 Example :
5557 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5558 frontend www
5559 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5560
5561 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5562
5563
5564monitor-uri <uri>
5565 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5567 yes | yes | yes | no
5568 Arguments :
5569 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5570 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5571
5572 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5573 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5574 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5575 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5576 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5577 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5578 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5579 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5580
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005581 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5582 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5583 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5584 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5585 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5586 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5587 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5588 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005589
5590 Example :
5591 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5592 frontend www
5593 mode http
5594 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5595
5596 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005598
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005599option abortonclose
5600no option abortonclose
5601 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5603 yes | no | yes | yes
5604 Arguments : none
5605
5606 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5607 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5608 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5609 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005610 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005611 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5612 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5613 encountered while delivering the response.
5614
5615 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5616 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5617 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5618 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5619 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5620 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005621 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005622 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005623 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005624 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5625 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5626 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5627
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005628 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5629 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005630 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5631 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5632 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5633 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5634 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5635 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005636 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005637
5638 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5639 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5640
5641 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5642
5643
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005644option accept-invalid-http-request
5645no option accept-invalid-http-request
5646 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5648 yes | yes | yes | no
5649 Arguments : none
5650
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005651 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005652 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005653 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005654 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5655 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5656 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5657 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5658 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005659 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5660 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5661 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5662 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005663 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005664 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005665 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5666 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5667 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005668
5669 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5670 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5671 been confirmed.
5672
5673 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5674 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005675 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5676 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005677 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5678
5679 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5680 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5681
5682 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5683 stats socket.
5684
5685
5686option accept-invalid-http-response
5687no option accept-invalid-http-response
5688 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5690 yes | no | yes | yes
5691 Arguments : none
5692
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005693 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005694 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005695 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005696 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5697 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5698 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5699 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5700 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005701 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5702 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5703 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005704
5705 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5706 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5707 been confirmed.
5708
5709 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5710 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5711 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5712 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5713
5714 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5715 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5716
5717 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5718 stats socket.
5719
5720
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005721option allbackups
5722no option allbackups
5723 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5725 yes | no | yes | yes
5726 Arguments : none
5727
5728 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5729 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5730 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5731 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5732 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5733 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5734 order between the backup servers anymore.
5735
5736 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5737 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5738
5739 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5740 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5741
5742
5743option checkcache
5744no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005745 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5747 yes | no | yes | yes
5748 Arguments : none
5749
5750 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5751 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005752 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005753 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5754 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005755 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005756
5757 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005758 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005759 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005760 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5761 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005762 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005763 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005764 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5765 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005766 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005767 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5768 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005769 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005770 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5771 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5772 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5773 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5774 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5775 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5776 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5777 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5778 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5779
5780 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005781 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005782 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005783 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005784 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5785
5786 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5787 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005788 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005789 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005790
5791 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5792 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5793
5794
5795option clitcpka
5796no option clitcpka
5797 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5799 yes | yes | yes | no
5800 Arguments : none
5801
5802 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5803 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005804 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005805 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5806
5807 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5808 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5809 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5810 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5811
5812 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5813 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5814 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5815 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5816 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5817
5818 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5819
5820 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5821 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5822 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5823
5824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5826
5827 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5828
5829
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005830option contstats
5831 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5833 yes | yes | yes | no
5834 Arguments : none
5835
5836 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5837 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5838 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5839 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005840 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5841 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5842 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5843 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5844 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005845
5846
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005847option dontlog-normal
5848no option dontlog-normal
5849 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5851 yes | yes | yes | no
5852 Arguments : none
5853
5854 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5855 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5856 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5857 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5858 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5859 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5860 logged.
5861
5862 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5863 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5864 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005866 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005867 logging.
5868
5869
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005870option dontlognull
5871no option dontlognull
5872 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5874 yes | yes | yes | no
5875 Arguments : none
5876
5877 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5878 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5879 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5880 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5881 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5882 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005883 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5884 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5885 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005886
5887 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005888 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005889 would not be logged.
5890
5891 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5892 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5893
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005894 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5895 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005896
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005897
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005898option forceclose (deprecated)
5899no option forceclose (deprecated)
5900 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005901
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005902 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005903
5904
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005905option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005906 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5908 yes | yes | yes | yes
5909 Arguments :
5910 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5911 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005912 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005913 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005914
5915 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5916 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5917 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5918 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5919 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5920 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5921 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005922 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5923 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5924 possible that the client has already brought one.
5925
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005926 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005927 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005928 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005929 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005930 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005931 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005932
5933 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5934 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5935 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5936 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5937 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5938 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5939 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5940
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005941 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5942 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5943 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5944 are under the control of the end-user.
5945
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005946 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005947 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5948 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005949 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5950 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5951 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005952
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005953 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005954 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5955 frontend www
5956 mode http
5957 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5958
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005959 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5960 backend www
5961 mode http
5962 option forwardfor header X-Client
5963
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005964 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005965 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005966
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005967
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005968option http-buffer-request
5969no option http-buffer-request
5970 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5972 yes | yes | yes | yes
5973 Arguments : none
5974
5975 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5976 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5977 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5978 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5979 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5980 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5981 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5982 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005983 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005984 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5985 default.
5986
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005987 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005988
5989
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005990option http-ignore-probes
5991no option http-ignore-probes
5992 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5994 yes | yes | yes | no
5995 Arguments : none
5996
5997 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5998 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5999 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6000 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6001 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6002 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6003 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6004 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6005 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006006 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6007 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006008 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6009
6010 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6011 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6012 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6013 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6014 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6015 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6016 are often the only way to detect them.
6017
6018 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6019 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6020
6021 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6022
6023
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006024option http-keep-alive
6025no option http-keep-alive
6026 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6028 yes | yes | yes | yes
6029 Arguments : none
6030
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006031 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6032 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006033 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6034 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6035 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6036 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6037 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006038
6039 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6040 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006041 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6042 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6043 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6044 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6045 situations where this option may be useful :
6046
6047 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006048 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006049
6050 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6051 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6052
6053 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6054 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6055 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6056 request.
6057
6058 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6059 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006060 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6061 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6062 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006063
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006064 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6065 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6066 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6067 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6068 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6069 not set.
6070
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006071 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006072 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6073 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006074
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006075 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006076 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006077 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006078
6079
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006080option http-no-delay
6081no option http-no-delay
6082 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6084 yes | yes | yes | yes
6085 Arguments : none
6086
6087 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6088 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6089 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6090 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6091 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6092 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6093 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6094 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6095 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6096 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6097 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6098 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6099 affected.
6100
6101 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6102 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6103 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6104 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6105 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6106 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6107 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6108 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6109 latency environments.
6110
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006111 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6112
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006113
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006114option http-pretend-keepalive
6115no option http-pretend-keepalive
6116 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006118 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006119 Arguments : none
6120
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006121 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006122 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6123 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6124 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6125 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6126 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6127 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6128 consider the response complete.
6129
6130 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6131 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6132 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6133 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006134 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006135 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6136
6137 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6138 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6139 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6140 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6141 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6142 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6143 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6144
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006145 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6146 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6147 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6148 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6149 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6150 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006151
6152 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6153 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6154
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006155 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006156 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006157
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006158
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006159option http-server-close
6160no option http-server-close
6161 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6163 yes | yes | yes | yes
6164 Arguments : none
6165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006166 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6167 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6168 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6169 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006170 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6171 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6172 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6173 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6174 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6175 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6176 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6177 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6178 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6179 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6180 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006181
6182 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6183 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6184 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6185 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006186 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6187 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006188
6189 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6190 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006191 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6192 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6193 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006194
6195 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6196 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006198 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6199 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006200
6201
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006202option http-tunnel
6203no option http-tunnel
6204 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006206 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006207 Arguments : none
6208
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006209 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6210 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6211 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6212 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006213 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006214
6215 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006216 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006217 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6218 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6219 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6220 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6221 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6222 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6223 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006224
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006225 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6226 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6227 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6228 backend.
6229
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6232
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006233 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6234 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006235
6236
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006237option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006238no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006239 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6241 yes | yes | yes | no
6242 Arguments : none
6243
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006244 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006245 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6246 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6247 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6248 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6249 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6250 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6251
6252 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6253 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006254 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6255 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6256 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006257
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006258 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6259 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6260 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6261 front of an existing proxy.
6262
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006263 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6264
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006265 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006266
6267
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006268option http-use-htx
6269no option http-use-htx
6270 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6272 yes | yes | yes | yes
6273 Arguments : none
6274
6275 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6276 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6277 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6278 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6279 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6280 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6281 representation.
6282
6283 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6284 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6285 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6286 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6287 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6288 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6289 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6290 other side's version.
6291
6292 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6293 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6294 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6295 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6296 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6297
6298 See also : "mode http"
6299
6300
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006301option httpchk
6302option httpchk <uri>
6303option httpchk <method> <uri>
6304option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6305 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6307 yes | no | yes | yes
6308 Arguments :
6309 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6310 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6311 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6312 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6313 ones.
6314
6315 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6316 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6317 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6318
6319 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6320 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6321 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6322 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6323 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6324
6325 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6326 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6327 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6328 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6329 the lack of any response.
6330
6331 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6332
6333 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6334 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6335 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6336
6337 Examples :
6338 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6339 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6340 backend https_relay
6341 mode tcp
6342 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6343 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6344
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006345 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6346 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6347 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006348
6349
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006350option httpclose
6351no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006352 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6354 yes | yes | yes | yes
6355 Arguments : none
6356
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006357 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6358 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6359 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6360 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006361 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006362
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006363 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6364 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6365 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6366 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6367 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006368
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006369 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6370 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6371 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006372
6373 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6374 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006375 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006376 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6377 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6378 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006379
6380 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6381 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6382
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006383 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006384
6385
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006386option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006387 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006389 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006390 Arguments :
6391 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6392 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6393 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006394 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006395 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006396
6397 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6398 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6399 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6400 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6401 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6402 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6403 ports.
6404
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006405 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6406 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006407
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006408 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006410 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006411
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006412
6413option http_proxy
6414no option http_proxy
6415 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6417 yes | yes | yes | yes
6418 Arguments : none
6419
6420 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6421 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6422 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6423 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6424 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6425
6426 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6427 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006428 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6429 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006430
6431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6433
6434 Example :
6435 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6436 backend direct_forward
6437 option httpclose
6438 option http_proxy
6439
6440 See also : "option httpclose"
6441
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006442
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006443option independent-streams
6444no option independent-streams
6445 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6447 yes | yes | yes | yes
6448 Arguments : none
6449
6450 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6451 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6452 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6453 receive data or not.
6454
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006455 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006456 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6457 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6458 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6459 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6460 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6461 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6462 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6463 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6464 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6465 socket buffers.
6466
6467 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6468 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6469 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6470 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6471 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6472
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006473 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006474 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6475 deprecated.
6476
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006477 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006478
6479
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006480option ldap-check
6481 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 yes | no | yes | yes
6484 Arguments : none
6485
6486 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6487 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6488 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6489 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6490
6491 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6492 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6493
6494 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6495 configure it.
6496
6497 Example :
6498 option ldap-check
6499
6500 See also : "option httpchk"
6501
6502
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006503option external-check
6504 Use external processes for server health checks
6505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6506 yes | no | yes | yes
6507
6508 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6509 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6510 command".
6511
6512 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6513
6514 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6515
6516
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006517option log-health-checks
6518no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006519 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6521 yes | no | yes | yes
6522 Arguments : none
6523
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006524 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6525 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6526 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006527
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006528 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6529 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6530 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6531 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6532 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6533
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006534 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006535 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006536
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006537 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6538 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6539 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006540
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006541
6542option log-separate-errors
6543no option log-separate-errors
6544 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6546 yes | yes | yes | no
6547 Arguments : none
6548
6549 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6550 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6551 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6552 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6553 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6554 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6555 provides very important information.
6556
6557 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6558 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6559 error logs.
6560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006561 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006562 logging.
6563
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006564
6565option logasap
6566no option logasap
6567 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6569 yes | yes | yes | no
6570 Arguments : none
6571
6572 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6573 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6574 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6575 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6576 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6577 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6578 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006579 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006580 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6581 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6582
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006583 Examples :
6584 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6585 mode http
6586 option httplog
6587 option logasap
6588 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6589
6590 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6591 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6592 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6593 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006595 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006596 logging.
6597
6598
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006599option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006600 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6602 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006603 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006604 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6605 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006606 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006607
6608 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6609 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006610 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006611 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6612 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6613 in the MySQL table, like this :
6614
6615 USE mysql;
6616 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6617 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6618
6619 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006620 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006621 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6622 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6623 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6624 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6625 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6626 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6627 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6628
6629 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6630 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006631
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006632 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006633
6634 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6635 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6636 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6637 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006638 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6639 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006640
6641 See also: "option httpchk"
6642
6643
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006644option nolinger
6645no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006646 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6648 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006649 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006650
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006651 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006652 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6653 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6654 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6655 connections.
6656
6657 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6658 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6659 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6660 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6661 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6662 this too.
6663
6664 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6665 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6666 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6667
6668 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6669 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6670 for servers.
6671
6672 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6673 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6674
6675
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006676option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6677 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6679 yes | yes | yes | yes
6680 Arguments :
6681 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6682 matching <network>
6683 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6684 header name.
6685
6686 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6687 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6688 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6689 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6690 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6691 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6692 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6693 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6694 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6695 possible that the client has already brought one.
6696
6697 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6698 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6699 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6700 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6701 header and requires different one.
6702
6703 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6704 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6705 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6706 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6707 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6708 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6709 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6710
6711 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6712 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6713 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6714 both are defined.
6715
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006716 Examples :
6717 # Original Destination address
6718 frontend www
6719 mode http
6720 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6721
6722 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6723 backend www
6724 mode http
6725 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6726
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006727 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006728
6729
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006730option persist
6731no option persist
6732 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6733 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6734 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006735 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006736
6737 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6738 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6739 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6740 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6741 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6742 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6743 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6744 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6745 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6746 redirected to another valid server.
6747
6748 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6749 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6750
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006751 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006752
6753
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006754option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6755 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6757 yes | no | yes | yes
6758 Arguments :
6759 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6760 PostgreSQL server.
6761
6762 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6763 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6764 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6765 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6766
6767 See also: "option httpchk"
6768
6769
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006770option prefer-last-server
6771no option prefer-last-server
6772 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6774 yes | no | yes | yes
6775 Arguments : none
6776
6777 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6778 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6779 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6780 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6781 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6782 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6783 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6784 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6785 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006786 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6787 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006788 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6789 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6790 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006791 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6792 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6793 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006794
6795 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6796 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6797
6798 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6799
6800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006801option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006802option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006803no option redispatch
6804 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6805 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6806 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006807 Arguments :
6808 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6809 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6810 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006811 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006812 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006813 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006814 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6815 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6816 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006818
6819 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6820 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6821 be able to access the service anymore.
6822
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006823 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6824 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006825
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006826 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006827 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6828 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006829
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006830 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6831 "redisp" keywords.
6832
6833 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6834 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6835
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006836 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006837
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006838
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006839option redis-check
6840 Use redis health checks for server testing
6841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6842 yes | no | yes | yes
6843 Arguments : none
6844
6845 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6846 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6847 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6848 find the "+PONG" response message.
6849
6850 Example :
6851 option redis-check
6852
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006853 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006854
6855
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006856option smtpchk
6857option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6858 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6860 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006861 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006862 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006863 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006864 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6865
6866 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6867 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6868 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6869
6870 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6871 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6872 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6873 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6874 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6875 dead server.
6876
6877 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6878 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006879 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006880 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6881
6882 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6883 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6884 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6885 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006886 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006887
6888 Example :
6889 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6890
6891 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006894option socket-stats
6895no option socket-stats
6896
6897 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6899 yes | yes | yes | no
6900
6901 Arguments : none
6902
6903
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006904option splice-auto
6905no option splice-auto
6906 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6908 yes | yes | yes | yes
6909 Arguments : none
6910
6911 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6912 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006913 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006914 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006915 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006916 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6917 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6918 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6919 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6920
6921 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6922 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6923 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6924 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6925 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6926 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6927 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6928 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6929 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6930 keyword.
6931
6932 Example :
6933 option splice-auto
6934
6935 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6936 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6937
6938 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6939 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6940
6941
6942option splice-request
6943no option splice-request
6944 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6946 yes | yes | yes | yes
6947 Arguments : none
6948
6949 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006950 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006951 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6952 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6953 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6954 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6955
6956 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6957
6958 Example :
6959 option splice-request
6960
6961 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6962 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6963
6964 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6965 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6966
6967
6968option splice-response
6969no option splice-response
6970 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6972 yes | yes | yes | yes
6973 Arguments : none
6974
6975 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006976 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006977 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6978 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6979 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6980 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6981
6982 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6983
6984 Example :
6985 option splice-response
6986
6987 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6988 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6989
6990 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6991 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6992
6993
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006994option spop-check
6995 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6997 no | no | no | yes
6998 Arguments : none
6999
7000 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7001 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7002 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7003 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7004
7005 Example :
7006 option spop-check
7007
7008 See also : "option httpchk"
7009
7010
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007011option srvtcpka
7012no option srvtcpka
7013 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7015 yes | no | yes | yes
7016 Arguments : none
7017
7018 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7019 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007020 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007021 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7022
7023 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7024 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7025 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7026 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7027
7028 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7029 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7030 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7031 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7032 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7033
7034 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7035
7036 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7037 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7038 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7039
7040 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7041 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7042
7043 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7044
7045
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007046option ssl-hello-chk
7047 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7049 yes | no | yes | yes
7050 Arguments : none
7051
7052 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7053 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7054 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7055 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7056 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7057 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7058 hello message.
7059
7060 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7061 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7062 messages, which is appreciable.
7063
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007064 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7065 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7066 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007067
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007068 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7069
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007070
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007071option tcp-check
7072 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7074 yes | no | yes | yes
7075
7076 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7077 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7078
7079 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7080 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7081 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7082
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007083 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007084 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7085 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7086 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7087 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7088 only.
7089
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007090 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007091 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7092 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7093 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7094 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7095
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007096 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007097 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7098 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007099 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007100 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7101 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7102 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7103 the respective protocols.
7104 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007105 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007106
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007107 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7108 script.
7109
7110 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7111 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7112 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7113 The "comment" is of course optional.
7114
7115
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007116 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007117 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007118 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007119 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007121 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007122 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007123 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007124
7125 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7126 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007127 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007128 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007129 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007130 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007131 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007132 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007133 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7134 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007135 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007136 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7137 tcp-check expect string +OK
7138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007139 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007140 (send many headers before analyzing)
7141 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007142 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007143 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7144 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7145 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7146 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007147 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007148
7149
7150 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7151
7152
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007153option tcp-smart-accept
7154no option tcp-smart-accept
7155 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7157 yes | yes | yes | no
7158 Arguments : none
7159
7160 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7161 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7162 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7163 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7164 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7165 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7166
7167 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7168 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7169 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7170 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7171
7172 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7173 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7174 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007175 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007176
7177 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7178 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7179 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7180
7181 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7182 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7183 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7184
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007185 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7186
7187
7188option tcp-smart-connect
7189no option tcp-smart-connect
7190 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7192 yes | no | yes | yes
7193 Arguments : none
7194
7195 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7196 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7197 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7198 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7199 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7200
7201 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7202 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7203 complex.
7204
7205 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7206 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7207 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7208
7209 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7210 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7211
7212 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7213
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007214
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007215option tcpka
7216 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7218 yes | yes | yes | yes
7219 Arguments : none
7220
7221 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7222 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007223 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007224 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7225
7226 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7227 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7228 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7229 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7230
7231 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7232 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7233 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7234 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7235 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7236
7237 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7238
7239 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7240 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7241 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7242 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7243 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7244 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7245 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7246 backends.
7247
7248 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7249
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007250
7251option tcplog
7252 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007254 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007255 Arguments : none
7256
7257 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7258 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7259 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7260 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7261 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7262 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7263 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7264 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7265
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007266 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007268 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007269
7270
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007271option transparent
7272no option transparent
7273 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007275 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007276 Arguments : none
7277
7278 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7279 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7280 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7281 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7282 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7283 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7284 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7285 appropriate server.
7286
7287 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7288 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7289
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007290 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007291 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007292
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007293
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007294external-check command <command>
7295 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7297 yes | no | yes | yes
7298
7299 Arguments :
7300 <command> is the external command to run
7301
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007302 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7303
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007304 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007305
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007306 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7307 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7308 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7309 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7310 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7311 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007312
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007313 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7314
7315 Environment variables :
7316 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7317 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7318
7319 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7320
7321 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7322
7323 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7324 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7325 for a UNIX socket).
7326
7327 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7328
7329 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7330
7331 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7332
7333 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7334
7335 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7336
7337 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7338 socket).
7339
7340 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7341 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7342
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007343 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7344 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7345 failed.
7346
7347 Example :
7348 external-check command /bin/true
7349
7350 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7351
7352
7353external-check path <path>
7354 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7356 yes | no | yes | yes
7357
7358 Arguments :
7359 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7360
7361 The default path is "".
7362
7363 Example :
7364 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7365
7366 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7367 "external-check command"
7368
7369
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007370persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007371persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007372 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7374 yes | no | yes | yes
7375 Arguments :
7376 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007377 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7378 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007379
7380 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7381 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007382 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007383 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7384 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7385 forwarded to this server.
7386
7387 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7388 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7389 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007390 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007391 a single "listen" section.
7392
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007393 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7394 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7395 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7396
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007397 Example :
7398 listen tse-farm
7399 bind :3389
7400 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7401 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7402 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7403 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7404 persist rdp-cookie
7405 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007406 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007407 balance rdp-cookie
7408 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7409 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7410
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007411 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7412 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007413
7414
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007415rate-limit sessions <rate>
7416 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7418 yes | yes | yes | no
7419 Arguments :
7420 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7421 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7422
7423 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7424 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7425 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7426 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7427 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7428 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7429
7430 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7431 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7432 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7433 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7434
7435 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7436 listen smtp
7437 mode tcp
7438 bind :25
7439 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007440 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007441
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007442 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7443 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7444 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007445
7446 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7447
7448
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007449redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7450redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7451redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007452 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7454 no | yes | yes | yes
7455
7456 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007457 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007458
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007459 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007460 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007461 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7462 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7463 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007464
7465 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7466 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7467 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7468 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7469 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007470 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7471 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7472 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7473 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007474
7475 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7476 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7477 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7478 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7479 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7480 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007481 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007482 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007483 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7484 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7485 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007486
7487 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007488 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7489 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7490 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007491 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007492 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7493 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7494 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7495 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007496
7497 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007498 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007499
7500 - "drop-query"
7501 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7502 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7503 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7504 with a location-type redirect.
7505
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007506 - "append-slash"
7507 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7508 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7509 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7510 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7511
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007512 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7513 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7514 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7515 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7516 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7517 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7518 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7519
7520 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7521 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7522 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7523 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7524 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7525 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7526 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007527
7528 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7529 acl clear dst_port 80
7530 acl secure dst_port 8080
7531 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007532 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007533 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007534 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7535
7536 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007537 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7538 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7539 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007540 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007541
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007542 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7543 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7544 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7545
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007546 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007547 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007548
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007549 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007550 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7551 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7552 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007554 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007555
7556
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007557redisp (deprecated)
7558redispatch (deprecated)
7559 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7560 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7561 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007562 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007563
7564 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7565 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7566 be able to access the service anymore.
7567
7568 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7569 redistribute them to a working server.
7570
7571 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7572 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7573 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007575 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7576 "option redispatch" instead.
7577
7578 See also : "option redispatch"
7579
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007580
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007581reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007582 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7584 no | yes | yes | yes
7585 Arguments :
7586 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7587 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007588 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007589
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007590 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7591 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7592
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007593 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7594 the last header of an HTTP request.
7595
7596 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7597 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7598 responses.
7599
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007600 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7601 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7602 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7603
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007604 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7605 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007606
7607
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007608reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7609reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007610 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7612 no | yes | yes | yes
7613 Arguments :
7614 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7615 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7616 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7617 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7618 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7619 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7620 ignores case.
7621
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007622 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7623 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7624
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007625 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7626 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7627 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7628 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007629 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007630
7631 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7632 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7633
7634 Example :
7635 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7636 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7637 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7638
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007639 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7640 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007641
7642
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007643reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7644reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007645 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7647 no | yes | yes | yes
7648 Arguments :
7649 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7650 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7651 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7652 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7653 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7654 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7655
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007656 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7657 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7658
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007659 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7660 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7661 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7662 next servers.
7663
7664 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7665 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7666 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7667
7668 Example :
7669 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7670 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7671 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7672
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007673 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7674 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007675
7676
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007677reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7678reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007679 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7681 no | yes | yes | yes
7682 Arguments :
7683 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7684 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7685 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7686 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7687 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7688 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7689 case.
7690
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007691 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7692 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7693
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007694 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7695 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7696 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7697 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007698 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007699
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007700 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007701 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007702 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007703
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007704 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7705 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7706
7707 Example :
7708 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7709 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7710 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7711
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007712 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7713 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007714
7715
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007716reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7717reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007718 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7720 no | yes | yes | yes
7721 Arguments :
7722 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7723 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7724 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7725 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7726 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7727 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7728 case.
7729
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007730 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7731 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7732
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007733 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7734 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7735 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7736 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7737
7738 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7739 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7740
7741 Example :
7742 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7743 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7744 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7745 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7746
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007747 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7748 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007749
7750
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007751reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7752reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007753 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7755 no | yes | yes | yes
7756 Arguments :
7757 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7758 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7759 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7760 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7761 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7762 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7763
7764 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7765 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7766 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7767 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007768 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007769
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007770 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7771 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7772
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007773 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7774 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7775 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7776
7777 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7778 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7779 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7780 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7781 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7782
7783 Example :
7784 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007785 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007786 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7787 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7788
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007789 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7790 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007791
7792
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007793reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7794reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007795 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7797 no | yes | yes | yes
7798 Arguments :
7799 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7800 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7801 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7802 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7803 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7804 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7805 ignores case.
7806
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007807 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7808 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7809
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007810 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7811 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007812 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7813 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7814 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007815 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7816 not set.
7817
7818 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7819 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7820 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7821 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7822 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7823
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007824 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007825 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007826 # block all others.
7827 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7828 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7829
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007830 # block bad guys
7831 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7832 reqitarpit . if badguys
7833
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007834 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7835 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007836
7837
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007838retries <value>
7839 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7840 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7841 yes | no | yes | yes
7842 Arguments :
7843 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7844 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7845 default value is 3.
7846
7847 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7848 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7849 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7850
7851 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007852 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7853 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007854
7855 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7856 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7857
7858 See also : "option redispatch"
7859
7860
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007861rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007862 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7864 no | yes | yes | yes
7865 Arguments :
7866 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7867 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007868 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007869
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007870 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7871 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7872
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007873 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7874 the last header of an HTTP response.
7875
7876 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7877 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7878 responses.
7879
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007880 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7881 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007882
7883
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007884rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7885rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007886 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7888 no | yes | yes | yes
7889 Arguments :
7890 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7891 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7892 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7893 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7894 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7895 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7896 ignores case.
7897
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007898 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7899 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7900
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007901 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7902 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007903 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007904 client.
7905
7906 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7907 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7908 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7909
7910 Example :
7911 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007912 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007913
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007914 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7915 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007916
7917
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007918rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7919rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007920 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7922 no | yes | yes | yes
7923 Arguments :
7924 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7925 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7926 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7927 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7928 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7929 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7930 ignores case.
7931
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007932 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7933 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7934
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007935 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7936 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7937 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7938 case-sensitive.
7939
7940 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007941 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7942 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7943 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007944
7945 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7946 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7947
7948 Example :
7949 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7950 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7951
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007952 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7953 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007954
7955
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007956rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7957rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007958 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7960 no | yes | yes | yes
7961 Arguments :
7962 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7963 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7964 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7965 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7966 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7967 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7968 ignores case.
7969
7970 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7971 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7972 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7973 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007974 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007975
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007976 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7977 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7978
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007979 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7980 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7981 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7982
7983 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7984 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7985 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7986 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7987 are not case-sensitive.
7988
7989 Example :
7990 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7991 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7992
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007993 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7994 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007995
7996
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007997server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007998 Declare a server in a backend
7999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8000 no | no | yes | yes
8001 Arguments :
8002 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008003 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008004 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008005
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008006 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8007 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8008 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8009 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008010 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8011 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8012 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8013 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8014 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008015 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8016 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8017 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8018 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8019 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8020 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8021 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008022 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008023 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8024 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8025 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8026 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8027 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8028 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008029 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8030 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008031 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8032 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008033
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008034 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008035 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8036 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8037 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8038 adding this value to the client's port.
8039
8040 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8041 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008042 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008043
8044 Examples :
8045 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8046 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008047 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008048 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8049 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8050 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008051
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008052 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8053 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8054 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8055 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8056 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8057
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008058 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8059 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008060
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008061server-state-file-name [<file>]
8062 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8063 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8064 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8065 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8066 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8067 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8068
8069 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8070 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8071
8072 global
8073 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8074
8075 backend bk
8076 load-server-state-from-file
8077
8078 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8079 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008080
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008081server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8082 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8083 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8085 no | no | yes | yes
8086
8087 Arguments:
8088 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8089
8090 <num | range>
8091 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8092 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8093 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8094 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8095
8096 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8097
8098 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8099
8100 <params*>
8101 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8102 keyword.
8103
8104 Examples:
8105 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8106 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8107 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8108
8109 # or
8110 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8111
8112 # would be equivalent to:
8113 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8114 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8115 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8116
8117
8118
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008119source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008120source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008121source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008122 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8124 yes | no | yes | yes
8125 Arguments :
8126 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8127 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008128
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008129 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008130 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8131 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8132 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8133 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8134 supported prefixes are :
8135 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8136 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8137 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008138 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008139 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8140 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008141
8142 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8143 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008144 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8145 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8146 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008147
8148 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8149 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8150 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8151 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8152 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8153 <addr>.
8154
8155 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8156 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8157 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8158 port.
8159
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008160 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8161 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8162 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8163 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008164 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008165 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8166 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8167 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8168 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8169 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8170 HTTP header.
8171
8172 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8173 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008174 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008175 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8176 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8177 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8178 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8179 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8180 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8181 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8182
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008183 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8184 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8185 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8186 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8187 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8188 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8189
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008190 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8191 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8192 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8193 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8194
8195 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8196 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8197 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8198 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8199 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8200 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8201
8202 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8203 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8204 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8205 there are two methods :
8206
8207 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8208 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8209 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8210 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8211 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8212 of the client ranges may be used.
8213
8214 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8215 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8216 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8217 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8218 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8219 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8220 same session.
8221
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008222 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8223 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8224 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008225 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008226
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008227 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8228
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008229 Examples :
8230 backend private
8231 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8232 source 192.168.1.200
8233
8234 backend transparent_ssl1
8235 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8236 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8237
8238 backend transparent_ssl2
8239 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8240 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8241 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8242
8243 backend transparent_ssl3
8244 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8245 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8246 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8247
8248 backend transparent_smtp
8249 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8250 # with Tproxy version 4.
8251 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8252
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008253 backend transparent_http
8254 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8255 # proxy.
8256 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008258 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008259 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8260
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008261
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008262srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8263 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8265 yes | no | yes | yes
8266 Arguments :
8267 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8268 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8269 as explained at the top of this document.
8270
8271 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8272 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8273 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8274 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8275 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8276 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8277 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8278
8279 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8280 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8281 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8282 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8283 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008284 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008285 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008286 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008287
8288 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8289 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8290 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8291 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8292 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8293 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8294
8295 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8296 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8297
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008298 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8299 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008300
8301
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008302stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8303 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008305 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008306
8307 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8308 matched.
8309
8310 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8311 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8312
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008313 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8314 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008315 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008316
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008317 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8318 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8319 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8320 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008321
8322 Example :
8323 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8324 backend stats_localhost
8325 stats enable
8326 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8327
8328 Example :
8329 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8330 backend stats_auth
8331 stats enable
8332 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8333 stats admin if TRUE
8334
8335 Example :
8336 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8337 userlist stats-auth
8338 group admin users admin
8339 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8340 group readonly users haproxy
8341 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8342
8343 backend stats_auth
8344 stats enable
8345 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8346 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8347 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8348 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8349
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008350 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8351 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8352 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008353
8354
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008355stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8356 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008358 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008359 Arguments :
8360 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8361
8362 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8363
8364 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8365 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8366 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8367 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8368 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8369 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8370
8371 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8372 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8373 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008374 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008375
8376 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8377 report using "stats scope".
8378
8379 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8380 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8381 unobvious parameters.
8382
8383 Example :
8384 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8385 backend public_www
8386 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8387 stats enable
8388 stats hide-version
8389 stats scope .
8390 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008391 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008392 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8393 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8394
8395 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8396 backend private_monitoring
8397 stats enable
8398 stats uri /admin?stats
8399 stats refresh 5s
8400
8401 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8402
8403
8404stats enable
8405 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008407 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008408 Arguments : none
8409
8410 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8411 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8412 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8413 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8414 - stats auth : no authentication
8415 - stats scope : no restriction
8416
8417 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8418 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8419 unobvious parameters.
8420
8421 Example :
8422 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8423 backend public_www
8424 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8425 stats enable
8426 stats hide-version
8427 stats scope .
8428 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008429 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008430 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8431 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8432
8433 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8434 backend private_monitoring
8435 stats enable
8436 stats uri /admin?stats
8437 stats refresh 5s
8438
8439 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8440
8441
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008442stats hide-version
8443 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008445 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008446 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008447
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008448 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8449 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8450 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8451 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8452 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8453 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008455 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8456 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8457 unobvious parameters.
8458
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008459 Example :
8460 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8461 backend public_www
8462 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008463 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008464 stats hide-version
8465 stats scope .
8466 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008467 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008468 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8469 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008470
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008471 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8472 backend private_monitoring
8473 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008474 stats uri /admin?stats
8475 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008476
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008477 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008478
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008479
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008480stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8481 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8482 Access control for statistics
8483
8484 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8485 no | no | yes | yes
8486
8487 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8488 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8489 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8490 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8491 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8492 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8493
8494 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8495 instance.
8496
8497 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8498 about ACL usage.
8499
8500
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008501stats realm <realm>
8502 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008504 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008505 Arguments :
8506 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8507 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8508 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8509
8510 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8511 using a backslash ('\').
8512
8513 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8514 only related to authentication.
8515
8516 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8517 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8518 unobvious parameters.
8519
8520 Example :
8521 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8522 backend public_www
8523 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8524 stats enable
8525 stats hide-version
8526 stats scope .
8527 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008528 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008529 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8530 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8531
8532 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8533 backend private_monitoring
8534 stats enable
8535 stats uri /admin?stats
8536 stats refresh 5s
8537
8538 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8539
8540
8541stats refresh <delay>
8542 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008544 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008545 Arguments :
8546 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8547 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8548 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8549 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8550 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8551 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8552
8553 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8554 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8555 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8556 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8557
8558 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8559 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8560 unobvious parameters.
8561
8562 Example :
8563 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8564 backend public_www
8565 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8566 stats enable
8567 stats hide-version
8568 stats scope .
8569 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008570 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008571 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8572 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8573
8574 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8575 backend private_monitoring
8576 stats enable
8577 stats uri /admin?stats
8578 stats refresh 5s
8579
8580 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8581
8582
8583stats scope { <name> | "." }
8584 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008586 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008587 Arguments :
8588 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8589 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8590 section in which the statement appears.
8591
8592 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8593 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8594 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8595 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8596 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8597 exists.
8598
8599 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8600 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8601 unobvious parameters.
8602
8603 Example :
8604 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8605 backend public_www
8606 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8607 stats enable
8608 stats hide-version
8609 stats scope .
8610 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008611 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008612 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8613 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8614
8615 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8616 backend private_monitoring
8617 stats enable
8618 stats uri /admin?stats
8619 stats refresh 5s
8620
8621 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8622
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008623
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008624stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008625 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008627 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008628
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008629 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008630 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8631
8632 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8633 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8634
8635 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8636 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008637 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008638
8639 Example :
8640 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8641 backend private_monitoring
8642 stats enable
8643 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8644 stats uri /admin?stats
8645 stats refresh 5s
8646
8647 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8648 global section.
8649
8650
8651stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008652 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8654 yes | yes | yes | yes
8655 Arguments : none
8656
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008657 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008658 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8659 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8660 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8661 - IP (socket, server)
8662 - cookie (backend, server)
8663
8664 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8665 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008666 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008667
8668 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8669
8670
8671stats show-node [ <name> ]
8672 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008674 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008675 Arguments:
8676 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8677 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8678
8679 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8680 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008681 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008682
8683 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8684 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8685 unobvious parameters.
8686
8687 Example:
8688 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8689 backend private_monitoring
8690 stats enable
8691 stats show-node Europe-1
8692 stats uri /admin?stats
8693 stats refresh 5s
8694
8695 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8696 section.
8697
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008698
8699stats uri <prefix>
8700 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008702 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008703 Arguments :
8704 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8705 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8706 query string.
8707
8708 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8709 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8710 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8711 possible to reach it in the application.
8712
8713 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008714 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008715 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8716 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8717 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8718 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8719
8720 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8721 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8722 an address or a port to statistics only.
8723
8724 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8725 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8726 unobvious parameters.
8727
8728 Example :
8729 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8730 backend public_www
8731 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8732 stats enable
8733 stats hide-version
8734 stats scope .
8735 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008736 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008737 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8738 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8739
8740 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8741 backend private_monitoring
8742 stats enable
8743 stats uri /admin?stats
8744 stats refresh 5s
8745
8746 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8747
8748
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008749stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8750 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008752 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008753
8754 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008755 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008756 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008757 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008758 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8759
8760 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8761 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8762 the "stick-table" statement.
8763
8764 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8765 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8766 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8767 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8768 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8769
8770 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8771 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8772 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8773 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8774 transformation rules.
8775
8776 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8777 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8778 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8779 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8780 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8781 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8782 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8783
8784 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8785 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8786 ACL based conditions.
8787
8788 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8789 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8790 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8791 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8792
8793 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8794 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8795 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8796 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8797
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008798 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8799 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008800 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008801
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008802 Example :
8803 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8804 # last 30 minutes
8805 backend pop
8806 mode tcp
8807 balance roundrobin
8808 stick store-request src
8809 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8810 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8811 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8812
8813 backend smtp
8814 mode tcp
8815 balance roundrobin
8816 stick match src table pop
8817 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8818 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8819
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008820 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008821 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008822
8823
8824stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8825 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8827 no | no | yes | yes
8828
8829 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8830 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8831 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8832 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8833
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008834 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8835 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008836 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008837
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008838 Examples :
8839 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008840 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008841
8842 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8843 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8844 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8845
8846
8847 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8848 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8849 backend http
8850 mode http
8851 balance roundrobin
8852 stick on src table https
8853 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8854 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8855 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8856
8857 backend https
8858 mode tcp
8859 balance roundrobin
8860 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8861 stick on src
8862 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8863 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8864
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008865 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008866
8867
8868stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8869 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8871 no | no | yes | yes
8872
8873 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008874 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008875 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008876 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008877 server is selected.
8878
8879 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8880 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8881 the "stick-table" statement.
8882
8883 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8884 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8885 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8886 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8887 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8888 address.
8889
8890 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8891 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8892 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8893 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8894 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8895 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8896 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8897 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8898 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8899 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8900
8901 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8902 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8903 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8904 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8905 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8906 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8907 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8908
8909 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8910 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8911 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8912 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8913
8914 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8915 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8916 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8917 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8918 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8919 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008920 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8921 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8922 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8923 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8924 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8925 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008926
8927 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8928 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8929 the request.
8930
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008931 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8932 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008933 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008934
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008935 Example :
8936 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8937 # last 30 minutes
8938 backend pop
8939 mode tcp
8940 balance roundrobin
8941 stick store-request src
8942 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8943 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8944 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8945
8946 backend smtp
8947 mode tcp
8948 balance roundrobin
8949 stick match src table pop
8950 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8951 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8952
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008953 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008954 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008955
8956
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008957stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008958 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8959 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008960 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008962 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008963
8964 Arguments :
8965 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8966 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8967 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8968 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8969
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008970 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8971 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8972 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8973 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8974
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008975 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8976 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8977 instance.
8978
8979 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8980 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8981 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8982 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8983 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8984 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008985 to 32 characters.
8986
8987 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8988 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8989 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008990 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008991 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8992 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008993
8994 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008995 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8996 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008997 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8998 increase.
8999
9000 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009001 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9002 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9003 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009004
9005 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9006 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9007 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9008 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009009 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009010 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9011 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9012 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9013 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9014 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9015 parameter (see below).
9016
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009017 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9018 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9019 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9020 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9021 soft restart.
9022
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009023 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9024 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009025
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009026 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9027 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9028 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9029 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009030 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009031 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009032 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9033 if not expiration delay is specified.
9034
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009035 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9036 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9037 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9038 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009039 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9040 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9041 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9042 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9043 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9044 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9045 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9046 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9047 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9048 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9049 types and their arguments.
9050
9051 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9052 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9053 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9054 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9055
9056 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9057 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9058 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009059 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009060
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009061 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9062 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9063 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009064 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009065 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009066 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009067
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009068 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9069 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9070 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9071 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9072
9073 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9074 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9075 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9076 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9077 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9078 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9079
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009080 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9081 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9082 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9083 they were received.
9084
9085 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9086 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9087 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9088 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9089 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9090
9091 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9092 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9093 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9094 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9095 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9096
9097 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9098 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9099 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9100
9101 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9102 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9103 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9104 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9105 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9106
9107 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9108 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9109 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9110 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9111 the client side.
9112
9113 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9114 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9115 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9116 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9117 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9118 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9119 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9120
9121 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9122 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9123 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9124 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9125 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9126 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009127 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009128
9129 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9130 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9131 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9132 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9133 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9134 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9135
9136 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009137 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009138 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9139 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9140
9141 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9142 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9143 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9144 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9145 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9146 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9147 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9148 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9149 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9150 recommended for better fairness.
9151
9152 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009153 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009154 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9155 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9156
9157 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9158 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9159 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9160 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9161 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9162 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9163 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9164 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9165 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9166 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009167
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009168 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9169 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009170 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9171 reference it.
9172
9173 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9174 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009175 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9176 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9177 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009178
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009179 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9180 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9181 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9182 something that can be ignored.
9183
9184 Example:
9185 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9186 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9187 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9188 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9189
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009190 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009191 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009192
9193
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009194stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009195 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9197 no | no | yes | yes
9198
9199 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009200 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009201 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009202 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009203 server is selected.
9204
9205 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9206 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9207 the "stick-table" statement.
9208
9209 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9210 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9211 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9212 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9213
9214 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9215 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9216 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9217 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9218 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9219 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009220 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009221 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9222 rules.
9223
9224 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9225 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9226 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9227 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9228 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9229 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9230 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9231
9232 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9233 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9234 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9235 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9236
9237 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9238 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9239 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9240 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9241 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9242 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009243 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9244 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9245 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9246 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9247 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9248 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9249 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9250 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9251 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009252
9253 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9254
9255 Example :
9256 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9257 backend https
9258 mode tcp
9259 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009260 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009261 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009262
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009263 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9264 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9265
9266 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9267 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9268 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9269
9270 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9271 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009272
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009273 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9274 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9275 # at offset 44.
9276
9277 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9278 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9279
9280 # Learn on response if server hello.
9281 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009282
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009283 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9284 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9285
9286 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9287 extraction.
9288
9289
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009290tcp-check connect [params*]
9291 Opens a new connection
9292 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9293 no | no | yes | yes
9294
9295 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9296 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9297 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9298
9299 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9300 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9301 of the sequence.
9302
9303 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9304 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9305 do.
9306
9307 Parameters :
9308 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9309 use the TCP connection.
9310
9311 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9312 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9313 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9314
9315 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9316
9317 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9318
9319 Examples:
9320 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9321 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9322 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9323 option tcp-check
9324 tcp-check connect
9325 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9326 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9327 tcp-check send \r\n
9328 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9329 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9330 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9331 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9332 tcp-check send \r\n
9333 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9334 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9335
9336 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9337 option tcp-check
9338 tcp-check connect port 110
9339 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9340 tcp-check connect port 143
9341 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9342 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9343
9344 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9345
9346
9347tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009348 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009349 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9350 no | no | yes | yes
9351
9352 Arguments :
9353 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9354 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9355 binary.
9356 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9357 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9358 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9359
9360 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9361 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9362 with the usual backslash ('\').
9363 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009364 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009365 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9366 used upper or lower case.
9367
9368
9369 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9370
9371 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9372 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9373 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9374 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9375 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9376 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9377 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9378 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9379
9380 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9381 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9382 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9383 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9384 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9385 expression.
9386
9387 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9388 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9389 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9390 this exact hexadecimal string.
9391 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9392
9393 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9394 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9395 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9396 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9397 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9398 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9399 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9400 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9401 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9402 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9403 the null character.
9404
9405 Examples :
9406 # perform a POP check
9407 option tcp-check
9408 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9409
9410 # perform an IMAP check
9411 option tcp-check
9412 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9413
9414 # look for the redis master server
9415 option tcp-check
9416 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009417 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009418 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9419 tcp-check expect string role:master
9420 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9421 tcp-check expect string +OK
9422
9423
9424 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9425 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9426
9427
9428tcp-check send <data>
9429 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9430 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9431 no | no | yes | yes
9432
9433 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9434 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9435
9436 Examples :
9437 # look for the redis master server
9438 option tcp-check
9439 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9440 tcp-check expect string role:master
9441
9442 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9443 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9444
9445
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009446tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9447 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009448 tcp health check
9449 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9450 no | no | yes | yes
9451
9452 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9453 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009454 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009455 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9456 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9457 hexadecimal string.
9458 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9459
9460 Examples :
9461 # redis check in binary
9462 option tcp-check
9463 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9464 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9465
9466
9467 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9468 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9469
9470
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009471tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9472 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9474 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009475 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009476 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9477 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009479 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009480
9481 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9482 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009483 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9484 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9485 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9486 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9487 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9488 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009489
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009490 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9491 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9492 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9493 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009494
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009495 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009496 - accept :
9497 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9498 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9499 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009500
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009501 - reject :
9502 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9503 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9504 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9505 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9506 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9507 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9508 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9509 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9510 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9511 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9512 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009513 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009514
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009515 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9516 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9517 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9518 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9519 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9520 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9521 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9522 hosts.
9523
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009524 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9525 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9526 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9527 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9528 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9529 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9530 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9531 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9532
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009533 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9534 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9535 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9536 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9537 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9538 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9539 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9540 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9541 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009542 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9543 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009544
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009545 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009546 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009547 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9548 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9549 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9550 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9551 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9552 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9553 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9554 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9555 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9556 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9557 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9558 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009559
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009560 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009561 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009562 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009563 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009564 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9565 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9566 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009567
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009568 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9569 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9570 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9571 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009572
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009573 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9574 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9575 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9576 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9577 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009578 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9579 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9580 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9581 layer7 information is extracted.
9582
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009583 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9584 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9585 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9586 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9587 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009588
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009589 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9590 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9591 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9592 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9593
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009594 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9595 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9596 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9597 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9598
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009599 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9600 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9601 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9602 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9603 continues.
9604
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009605 - set-src <expr> :
9606 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9607 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9608 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009609 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009610
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009611 Arguments:
9612 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9613 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009614
9615 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009616 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9617
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009618 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9619 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009620
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009621 - set-src-port <expr> :
9622 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9623 expression.
9624
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009625 Arguments:
9626 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9627 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009628
9629 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009630 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9631
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009632 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9633 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9634 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009635
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009636 - set-dst <expr> :
9637 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9638 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9639 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9640 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9641 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9642
9643 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9644 followed by some converters.
9645
9646 Example:
9647
9648 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9649 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9650
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009651 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9652 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9653
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009654 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9655 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9656 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9657 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9658
9659
9660 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9661 followed by some converters.
9662
9663 Example:
9664
9665 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9666
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009667 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9668 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9669 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9670
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009671 - "silent-drop" :
9672 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009673 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009674 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9675 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9676 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9677 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9678 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009679 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9680 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009681 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9682 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009683 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009684 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9685 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9686 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9687 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9688
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009689 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9690 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9691 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009692
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009693 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9694 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9695 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009696
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009697 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009698 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009699 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009700
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009701 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9702 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9703 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009704
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009705 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009706 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9707 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009708
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009709 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9710
9711 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9712
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009713 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9714
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009715 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009716
9717
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009718tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9719 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009721 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009722 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009723 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9724 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009725
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009726 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009727
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009728 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009729 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9730 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9731 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9732 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009733
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009734 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9735 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9736 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9737 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009738 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9739 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9740 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9741 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9742 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9743 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009744 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009745 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009746
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009747 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9748 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9749 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9750 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009751
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009752 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009753 - accept : the request is accepted
9754 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9755 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009756 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009757 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009758 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009759 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009760 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009761 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009762 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009763 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009764 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009765
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009766 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9767 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009768
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009769 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9770 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9771 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9772 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9773 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9774 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009775
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009776 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009777 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9778 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009779
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009780 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009781 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9782 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9783 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9784 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009785 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9786 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9787 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009788
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009789 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009790 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9791 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9792 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009793
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009794 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009795 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9796 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009797
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009798 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9799 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009800 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009801 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9802 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009803 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009804 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009805 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009806 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9807 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009808 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009809 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9810 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009811
9812 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9813 followed by some converters.
9814
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009815 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9816 <var-name>.
9817
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009818 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9819 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9820 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9821 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9822 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9823
9824 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9825 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9826 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9827 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9828 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9829 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9830 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9831 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9832 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9833 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9834 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9835
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009836 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9837 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9838 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9839 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9840 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9841
9842 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9843
9844 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9845
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009846 Example:
9847
9848 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009849 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009850
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009851 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009852 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9853 # and reject everything else.
9854 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9855 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009856 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009857 tcp-request content reject
9858
9859 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009860 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9861 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9862 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009863 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009864
9865 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9866 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9867 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009868 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009869 tcp-request content reject
9870
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009871 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009872 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009873 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009874 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009875 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9876 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009877
9878 Example:
9879 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9880 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009881 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009882
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009883 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009884 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009885
9886 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009887 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009888 # protecting all our sites
9889 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009890 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9891 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009892 ...
9893 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9894
9895 backend http_dynamic
9896 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009897 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009898 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009899 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009900 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009901 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009902 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009904 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009905
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009906 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9907 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009908
9909
9910tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9911 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009913 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009914 Arguments :
9915 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9916 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9917 as explained at the top of this document.
9918
9919 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9920 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9921 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9922 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9923 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9924
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009925 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9926 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9927 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9928 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9929
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009930 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9931 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009932 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009933 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009934 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9935 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9936 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9937 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009938
9939 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9940 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9941 it pass through unaffected.
9942
9943 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9944 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9945 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009946 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009947 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9948 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009949 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9950 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9951 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009952
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009953 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009954 "timeout client".
9955
9956
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009957tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9958 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9960 no | no | yes | yes
9961 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009962 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9963 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009964
9965 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9966
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009967 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009968 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9969 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009970 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9971 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009972
9973 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9974
9975 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9976 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9977 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9978 inserted.
9979
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009980 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009981 - accept :
9982 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9983 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9984 the rules evaluation.
9985
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009986 - close :
9987 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9988 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9989 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9990 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9991 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9992 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009993 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009994 protocols.
9995
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009996 - reject :
9997 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9998 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009999 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010000
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010001 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10002 Sets a variable.
10003
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010004 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10005 Unsets a variable.
10006
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010007 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10008 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10009 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10010 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10011
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010012 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10013 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10014 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10015 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10016
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010017 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10018 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10019 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10020 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10021 continues.
10022
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010023 - "silent-drop" :
10024 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010025 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010026 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10027 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10028 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10029 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10030 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010031 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10032 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010033 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10034 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010035 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010036 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10037 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10038 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10039 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10040
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010041 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10042 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10043
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010044 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10045 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10046 for changing the default action to a reject.
10047
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010048 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10049 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10050 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10051 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010052 period.
10053
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010054 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10055 declared inline.
10056
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010057 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10058 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010059 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010060 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10061 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010062 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010063 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010064 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010065 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10066 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010067 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010068 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10069 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010070
10071 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10072 followed by some converters.
10073
10074 Example:
10075
10076 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10077
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010078 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10079 <var-name>.
10080
10081 Example:
10082
10083 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10084
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010085 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10086 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10087 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10088 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10089 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10090
10091 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10092
10093 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10094
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010095 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10096
10097 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10098
10099
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010100tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10101 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10103 no | yes | yes | no
10104 Arguments :
10105 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10106 below.
10107
10108 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10109
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010110 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010111 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10112 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10113 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10114 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10115 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10116 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10117 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010118 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010119 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10120 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10121 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10122 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10123 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10124 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10125 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10126 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10127 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10128 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10129 instead.
10130
10131 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10132 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10133 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10134 rules which may be inserted.
10135
10136 Several types of actions are supported :
10137 - accept : the request is accepted
10138 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10139 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10140 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010141 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010142 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10143 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010144 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010145 - silent-drop
10146
10147 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10148 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10149 sections for a complete description.
10150
10151 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10152 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10153 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10154
10155 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10156 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10157 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10158 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10159 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10160
10161 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10162 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10163
10164 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10165 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10166 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10167
10168 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10169 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10170 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10171
10172 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10173 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10174 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10175
10176 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10177 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10178 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10179
10180 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10181
10182 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10183
10184
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010185tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10186 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10188 no | no | yes | yes
10189 Arguments :
10190 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10191 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10192 as explained at the top of this document.
10193
10194 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10195
10196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010197timeout check <timeout>
10198 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10199 established.
10200
10201 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10202 yes | no | yes | yes
10203 Arguments:
10204 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10205 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10206 as explained at the top of this document.
10207
10208 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10209 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010210 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010211 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010212 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10213 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10214 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010215
10216 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10217 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10218
10219 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10220 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010221 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010222
10223 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10224 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10225 forget about it.
10226
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010227 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10228 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010229
10230
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010231timeout client <timeout>
10232timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10233 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10235 yes | yes | yes | no
10236 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010237 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010238 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10239 as explained at the top of this document.
10240
10241 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10242 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10243 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010244 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10245 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10246 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10247 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010248 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10249 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10250 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010251 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010252 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010253 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10254 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010255 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10256 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010257
10258 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10259 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10260 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10261 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10262 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10263 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10264
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010265 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010266
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010267 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10268 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10269 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10270
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010271 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10272 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010273
10274
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010275timeout client-fin <timeout>
10276 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10278 yes | yes | yes | no
10279 Arguments :
10280 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10281 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10282 as explained at the top of this document.
10283
10284 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10285 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10286 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10287 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10288 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10289 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10290 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010291 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10292 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10293 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010294
10295 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10296 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10297 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10298
10299 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10300
10301
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010302timeout connect <timeout>
10303timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10304 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10306 yes | no | yes | yes
10307 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010308 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010309 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10310 as explained at the top of this document.
10311
10312 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010313 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010314 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010315 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010316 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10317 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010318
10319 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10320 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10321 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10322 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10323 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10324 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10325
10326 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10327 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10328 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10329
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010330 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10331 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010332
10333
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010334timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10335 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10337 yes | yes | yes | yes
10338 Arguments :
10339 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10340 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10341 as explained at the top of this document.
10342
10343 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10344 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10345 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10346 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10347 once the request has started to present itself.
10348
10349 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10350 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10351 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10352 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10353 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10354
10355 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10356 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10357 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10358 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10359
10360 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10361 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010362 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010363 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10364 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010365 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010366
10367 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10368 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10369 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10370 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10371
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010372 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10373 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010374 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10375
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010376 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10377
10378
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010379timeout http-request <timeout>
10380 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010382 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010383 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010384 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010385 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10386 as explained at the top of this document.
10387
10388 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10389 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10390 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10391 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10392 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10393 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10394 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010395 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10396 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10397 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10398 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010399 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010400 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10401 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010402
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010403 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10404 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10405 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10406 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10407 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010408 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010409
10410 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10411 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010412 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010413 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10414 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10415
10416 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010417 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10418 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10419 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010420
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010421 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010422 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010423
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010424
10425timeout queue <timeout>
10426 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10428 yes | no | yes | yes
10429 Arguments :
10430 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10431 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10432 as explained at the top of this document.
10433
10434 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10435 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10436 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10437 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10438 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10439
10440 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10441 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10442 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10443 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10444
10445 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10446
10447
10448timeout server <timeout>
10449timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10450 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10452 yes | no | yes | yes
10453 Arguments :
10454 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10455 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10456 as explained at the top of this document.
10457
10458 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10459 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10460 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10461 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10462 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10463 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10464 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10465
10466 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10467 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10468 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10469 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10470 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010471 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010472 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010473 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10474 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010475 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10476 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010477
10478 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10479 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10480 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10481 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10482 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10483 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10484
10485 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10486 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10487 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10488
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010489 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010490
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010491
10492timeout server-fin <timeout>
10493 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10495 yes | no | yes | yes
10496 Arguments :
10497 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10498 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10499 as explained at the top of this document.
10500
10501 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10502 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10503 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10504 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10505 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10506 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10507 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10508 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10509 situations, it should not be needed.
10510
10511 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10512 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10513 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10514
10515 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10516
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010517
10518timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010519 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10521 yes | yes | yes | yes
10522 Arguments :
10523 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10524 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10525 as explained at the top of this document.
10526
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010527 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10528 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10529 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10530 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010531
10532 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10533 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10534 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10535 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010536 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010537
10538 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10539
10540
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010541timeout tunnel <timeout>
10542 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10544 yes | no | yes | yes
10545 Arguments :
10546 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10547 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10548 as explained at the top of this document.
10549
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010550 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010551 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10552 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10553 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010554 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10555 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010556 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10557 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10558 specified.
10559
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010560 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10561 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10562 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10563 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10564 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10565 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10566 state.
10567
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010568 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10569 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10570 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10571 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010572 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010573
10574 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10575 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10576 forget about it.
10577
10578 Example :
10579 defaults http
10580 option http-server-close
10581 timeout connect 5s
10582 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010583 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010584 timeout server 30s
10585 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10586
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010587 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010588
10589
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010590transparent (deprecated)
10591 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010593 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010594 Arguments : none
10595
10596 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10597 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10598 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10599 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10600 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10601 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10602 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10603 appropriate server.
10604
10605 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10606
10607 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10608 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10609
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010610 See also: "option transparent"
10611
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010612unique-id-format <string>
10613 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10615 yes | yes | yes | no
10616 Arguments :
10617 <string> is a log-format string.
10618
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010619 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10620 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10621 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10622 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010623
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010624 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10625 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10626 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10627 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10628 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10629 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10630 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10631 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010632
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010633 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10634 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010635
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010636 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010637
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010638 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010639
10640 will generate:
10641
10642 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10643
10644 See also: "unique-id-header"
10645
10646unique-id-header <name>
10647 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10649 yes | yes | yes | no
10650 Arguments :
10651 <name> is the name of the header.
10652
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010653 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10654 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010655
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010656 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010657
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010658 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010659 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10660
10661 will generate:
10662
10663 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10664
10665 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010666
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010667use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010668 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10670 no | yes | yes | no
10671 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010672 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10673 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010674
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010675 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10676 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010677
10678 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10679 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10680 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010681 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010682 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010683 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10684 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010685
10686 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10687 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10688 assign the backend.
10689
10690 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10691 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10692 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10693 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10694 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10695 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10696
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010697 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010698 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010699 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10700 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10701 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10702
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010703 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10704 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10705 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10706 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10707 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10708 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10709 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10710 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10711 cannot be forced from the request.
10712
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010713 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010714 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10715 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10716
10717 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10718 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010719
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010720
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010721use-server <server> if <condition>
10722use-server <server> unless <condition>
10723 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10725 no | no | yes | yes
10726 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010727 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010728
10729 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10730
10731 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10732 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10733 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10734
10735 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10736 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10737 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10738 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10739 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10740 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10741 matches will assign the server.
10742
10743 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10744 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10745 with the next rules until one matches.
10746
10747 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10748 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10749 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10750 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10751
10752 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10753 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10754 stripped.
10755
10756 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10757 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10758 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10759 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10760
10761 Example :
10762 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10763 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10764 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10765 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10766 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10767 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010768 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010769 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10770 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10771
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010772 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010773
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010774
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107755. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010776--------------------------
10777
10778The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10779depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10780settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10781written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10782described in this section.
10783
10784
107855.1. Bind options
10786-----------------
10787
10788The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10789as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10790no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10791parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10792while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10793provided immediately after the setting name.
10794
10795The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10796
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010797accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10798 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10799 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10800 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10801 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10802 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10803 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10804 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10805 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10806 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010807 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10808 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10809 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010810
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010811accept-proxy
10812 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010813 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10814 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010815 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10816 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10817 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10818 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010819 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010820 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10821 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010822 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10823 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010824
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010825allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010826 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010827 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10828 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10829 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10830 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010831
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010832alpn <protocols>
10833 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10834 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10835 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10836 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10837 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010838 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10839 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10840 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10841 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10842 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10843 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10844 preference, like below :
10845
10846 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010847
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010848backlog <backlog>
10849 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10850 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10851
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010852curves <curves>
10853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10854 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10855 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10856 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10857 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10858 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10859
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010860ecdhe <named curve>
10861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010862 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10863 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010864
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010865ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10867 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10868 client's certificate.
10869
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010870ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10872 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10873 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10874 error is ignored.
10875
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010876ca-sign-file <cafile>
10877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10878 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10879 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10880 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10881 'generate-certificates' for details.
10882
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010883ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010884 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10885 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10886 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10887 'generate-certificates' for details.
10888
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010889ciphers <ciphers>
10890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10891 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010892 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3. The format of the
10893 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for
10894 instance a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without
10895 quotes). Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list
10896 of suitable ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background
10897 information and recommendations see e.g.
10898 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10899 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10900 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10901
10902ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10904 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10905 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10906 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
10907 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section, and can be for instance a
10908 string such as
10909 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
10910 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
10911 the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010912
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010913crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010914 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10915 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10916 to verify client's certificate.
10917
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010918crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010919 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10920 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10921 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10922 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10923 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10924 file.
10925
10926 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10927 are loaded.
10928
10929 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010930 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010931 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10932 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10933 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10934 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010935 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10936 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010937 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010938
10939 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10940 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10941 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10942 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010943 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10944 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010945
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010946 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010947
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010948 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010949 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010950 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10951 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010952 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10953 clients).
10954
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010955 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10956 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10957 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10958 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10959 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10960 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10961 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10962 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10963 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10964 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10965 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10966 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10967 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10968
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010969 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10970 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10971 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10972 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10973 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10974
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010975 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10976 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10977 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10978 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010979
10980 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10981 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10982 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10983 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10984 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10985 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10986 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10987 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10988 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10989
10990 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10991
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010992 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010993 a cert bundle.
10994
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010995 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010996 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10997 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10998 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10999 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11000 provide multi-cert support.
11001
11002 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11003
11004 Filename | CN | SAN
11005 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11006 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011007 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011008 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11009 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11010
11011 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11012 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11013 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11014 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011015 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11016 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11017 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011018
11019 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11020 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11021
11022 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11023 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11024 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11025
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011026crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011027 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011028 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011029 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011030 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011031
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011032crt-list <file>
11033 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011034 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11035 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011036
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011037 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11038
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011039 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11040 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011041 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011042 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011043
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011044 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11045 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11046 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11047 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11048 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11049 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11050 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11051 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011052
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011053 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011054 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011055 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11056 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11057 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011058
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011059 crt-list file example:
11060 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011061 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011062 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011063 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011064
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011065defer-accept
11066 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11067 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11068 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011069 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011070 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11071 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11072 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11073 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11074 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11075 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11076 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11077
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011078expose-fd listeners
11079 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11080 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011081 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11082 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011083 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011084
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011085force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011086 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011087 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011088 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011089 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011090
11091force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011092 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011093 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011094 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011095
11096force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011097 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011098 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011099 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011100
11101force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011102 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011103 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011104 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011105
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011106force-tlsv13
11107 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11108 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011109 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011110
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011111generate-certificates
11112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11113 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11114 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11115 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11116 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11117 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11118 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11119 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11120 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11121 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11122 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11123
11124 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11125 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011126 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011127 certificate is used many times.
11128
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011129gid <gid>
11130 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11131 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11132 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11133 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11134 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11135
11136group <group>
11137 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11138 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11139 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11140 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11141 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11142
11143id <id>
11144 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11145 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11146 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11147 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11148
11149interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011150 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11151 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11152 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11153 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11154 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11155 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011156 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11157 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11158 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11159 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11160 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11161 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011162
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011163level <level>
11164 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11165 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11166 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011167 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011168 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11169 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11170 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011171 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011172 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011173 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011174 all counters).
11175
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011176severity-output <format>
11177 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11178 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11179 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11180 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11181 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11182 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11183 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11184 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11185 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11186 rfc5424 convention.
11187
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011188maxconn <maxconn>
11189 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11190 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11191 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11192 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11193 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11194 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11195 eat all memory.
11196
11197mode <mode>
11198 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11199 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11200 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11201 UNIX sockets.
11202
11203mss <maxseg>
11204 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11205 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11206 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11207 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11208 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11209 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11210 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11211 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11212 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11213 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11214 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11215
11216name <name>
11217 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11218 page.
11219
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011220namespace <name>
11221 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11222 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11223 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11224 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11225
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011226nice <nice>
11227 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11228 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11229 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11230 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11231 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11232 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11233 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11234 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11235 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11236 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11237 one for an RDP socket.
11238
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011239no-ca-names
11240 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11241 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11242
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011243no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011245 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011246 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011247 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011248 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11249 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011250
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011251no-tls-tickets
11252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11253 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11254 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011255 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11256 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011257
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011258no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011260 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011261 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011262 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011263 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11264 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011265
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011266no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011268 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011269 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011270 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011271 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11272 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011273
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011274no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011276 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011277 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011278 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011279 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11280 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011281
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011282no-tlsv13
11283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11284 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11285 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11286 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011287 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11288 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011289
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011290npn <protocols>
11291 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11292 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11293 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11294 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011295 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011296 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11297 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11298 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11299 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11300 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011301
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011302prefer-client-ciphers
11303 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11304 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11305 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011306 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11307 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11308 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011309
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011310process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11311 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11312 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011313 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011314 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11315 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11316 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11317 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011318 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011319 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11320 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11321 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11322
11323 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11324
11325 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11326 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11327 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11328 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11329 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11330 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11331 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11332 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011333
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011334proto <name>
11335 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11336 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11337 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11338 in haproxy -vv.
11339 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11340 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011341 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011342 h2" on the bind line.
11343
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011344ssl
11345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011346 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011347 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11348 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011349 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11350 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011351
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011352ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11353 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11354 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11355 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11356
11357ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11358 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11359 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11360 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11361
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011362strict-sni
11363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11364 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11365 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11366 See the "crt" option for more information.
11367
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011368tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011369 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011370 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11371 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011372 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011373 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11374 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11375 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11376 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11377 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11378 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11379 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11380
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011381tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011382 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011383 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11384 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11385 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11386 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11387 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11388 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11389 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011390 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11391 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11392 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011393
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011394tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11395 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011396 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11397 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11398 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11399 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11400 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11401 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11402 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11403 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11404 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11405 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011406 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11407 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11408
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011409transparent
11410 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11411 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11412 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11413 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11414 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11415 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11416 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11417 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11418 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11419 so check for support with your vendor.
11420
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011421v4v6
11422 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11423 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11424 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11425 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011426 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011427
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011428v6only
11429 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11430 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11431 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011432 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11433 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011434
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011435uid <uid>
11436 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11437 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11438 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11439 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11440 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11441
11442user <user>
11443 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11444 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11445 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11446 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11447 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11448
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011449verify [none|optional|required]
11450 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11451 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11452 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11453 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11454 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011455 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11456 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11457 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11458 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011459
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114605.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011461------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011463The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11464which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11465arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11466settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11467after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11468Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11469address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011471 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011472 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011473
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011474Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11475keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011477The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011478
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011479addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011480 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011481 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11482 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11483 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11484 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11485 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011486
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011487agent-check
11488 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011489 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011490 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11491 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11492 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011493
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011494 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011495 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011496 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11497 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11498 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011499
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011500 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11501 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11502 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11503 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11504 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011505
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011506 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011507 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011508
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011509 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11510 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11511 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011512
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011513 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11514 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11515 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011516
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011517 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11518 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11519 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11520 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11521 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011522 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011523 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011524
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011525 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11526 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011527
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011528 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11529 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11530 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11531 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11532 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11533 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11534 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11535 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11536 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011537
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011538 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11539 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011540 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11541 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11542 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011543 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011544
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011545 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011546 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011547
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011548agent-send <string>
11549 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11550 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11551 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11552 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11553 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11554
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011555agent-inter <delay>
11556 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11557 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11558
11559 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11560 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11561 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11562 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11563 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11564 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11565 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11566 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11567 of backends use the same servers.
11568
11569 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11570
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011571agent-addr <addr>
11572 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11573
11574 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11575 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11576 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11577 hostname, it will be resolved.
11578
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011579agent-port <port>
11580 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11581
11582 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11583
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011584alpn <protocols>
11585 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11586 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11587 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11588 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11589 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11590 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11591 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11592 now obsolete NPN extension.
11593 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11594 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11595
11596 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011598backup
11599 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11600 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11601 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11602 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011603 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11604 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011605
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011606ca-file <cafile>
11607 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11608 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11609 server's certificate.
11610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011611check
11612 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011613 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11614 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11615 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11616 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11617 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11618 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11619 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011620 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11621 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011622 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11623 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011624
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011625check-send-proxy
11626 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11627 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11628 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11629 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11630 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11631 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11632 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11633
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011634check-alpn <protocols>
11635 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11636 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11637 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11638
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011639check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011640 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011641 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11642 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011643
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011644check-ssl
11645 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11646 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11647 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11648 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011649 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011650 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11651 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011652 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011653 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11654 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011655
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011656ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011657 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11658 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11659 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011660 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11661 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11662 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11663 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11664 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11665 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11666
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011667ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11668 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11669 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11670 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11671 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
11672 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section.
11673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011674cookie <value>
11675 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11676 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11677 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11678 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11679 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11680 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11681 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11682
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011683crl-file <crlfile>
11684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11685 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11686 to verify server's certificate.
11687
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011688crt <cert>
11689 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11690 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11691 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11692 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11693 certificate request.
11694
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011695disabled
11696 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11697 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11698 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11699 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11700 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011701 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011702
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011703enabled
11704 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11705 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11706 default value.
11707 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11708 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011710error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011711 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11712 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11713 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011714
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011715 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011717fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011718 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11719 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11720 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11721
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011722force-sslv3
11723 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11724 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011725 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011726 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011727
11728force-tlsv10
11729 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011730 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011731 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011732
11733force-tlsv11
11734 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011735 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011736 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011737
11738force-tlsv12
11739 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011740 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011741 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011742
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011743force-tlsv13
11744 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11745 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011746 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011748id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011749 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11750 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11751 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011752
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011753init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11754 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11755 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011756 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011757 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11758 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11759 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11760 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11761 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11762 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11763 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11764 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11765 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011766 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011767 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11768 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11769 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11770 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11771 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11772 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011773 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011774
11775 Example:
11776 defaults
11777 # never fail on address resolution
11778 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011780inter <delay>
11781fastinter <delay>
11782downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011783 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11784 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11785 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11786 between checks depending on the server state :
11787
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011788 Server state | Interval used
11789 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11790 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11791 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11792 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11793 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11794 or yet unchecked. |
11795 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11796 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11797 | "inter" otherwise.
11798 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011800 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11801 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11802 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11803 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011804 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11805 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11806 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11807 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11808 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011810maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011811 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11812 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11813 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11814 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11815 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11816 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11817 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11818 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011820maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011821 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11822 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11823 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11824 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11825 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11826 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11827 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011829minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011830 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11831 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11832 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11833 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11834 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11835 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011836 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011837 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011838
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011839namespace <name>
11840 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11841 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11842 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11843 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11844
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011845no-agent-check
11846 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11847 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11848 default value.
11849 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11850 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11851
11852no-backup
11853 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11854 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11855 default value.
11856 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11857 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11858
11859no-check
11860 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11861 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11862 default value.
11863 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11864 "default-server" "check" setting.
11865
11866no-check-ssl
11867 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11868 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11869 default value.
11870 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11871 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11872
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011873no-send-proxy
11874 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11875 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11876 default value.
11877 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11878 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11879
11880no-send-proxy-v2
11881 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11882 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11883 default value.
11884 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11885 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11886
11887no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11888 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11889 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11890 default value.
11891 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11892 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11893
11894no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11895 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11896 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11897 default value.
11898 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11899 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11900
11901no-ssl
11902 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11903 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11904 default value.
11905 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11906 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11907
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011908no-ssl-reuse
11909 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11910 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11911 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11912 and for paranoid users.
11913
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011914no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011915 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11916 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011917 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011918
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011919 Supported in default-server: No
11920
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011921no-tls-tickets
11922 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11923 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11924 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011925 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11926 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011927 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011928
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011929no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011930 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011931 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11932 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011933 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11934 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011935 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011936
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011937 Supported in default-server: No
11938
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011939no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011940 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011941 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11942 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011943 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11944 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011945 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011946
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011947 Supported in default-server: No
11948
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011949no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011950 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011951 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11952 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011953 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11954 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011955 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011956
11957 Supported in default-server: No
11958
11959no-tlsv13
11960 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11961 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11962 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11963 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11964 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011965 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011966
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011967 Supported in default-server: No
11968
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011969no-verifyhost
11970 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11971 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11972 default value.
11973 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11974 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011975
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011976non-stick
11977 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11978 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11979 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11980
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011981npn <protocols>
11982 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11983 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11984 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11985 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11986 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11987 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11988 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011990observe <mode>
11991 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11992 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11993 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11994 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11995 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11996 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011997 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011998
11999 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012001on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012002 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12003 Currently, four modes are available:
12004 - fastinter: force fastinter
12005 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12006 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12007 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12008 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12009
12010 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12011
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012012on-marked-down <action>
12013 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12014 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012015 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12016 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12017 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12018 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12019 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12020 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12021 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12022 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012023
12024 Actions are disabled by default
12025
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012026on-marked-up <action>
12027 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12028 Currently one action is available:
12029 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12030 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12031 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12032 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012033 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12034 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012035 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12036 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12037
12038 Actions are disabled by default
12039
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012040pool-max-conn <max>
12041 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12042 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12043 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12044 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12045 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12046 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12047
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012048pool-purge-delay <delay>
12049 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
12050 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means it's never purged. The default is
12051 1s.
12052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012053port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012054 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12055 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12056 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12057 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12058 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12059 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12060
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012061proto <name>
12062
12063 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12064 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12065 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12066 reported in haproxy -vv.
12067 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12068 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012070redir <prefix>
12071 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12072 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12073 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12074 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12075 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12076 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12077 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12078 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012079 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012080 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012081 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12082 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12083 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12084 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12085
12086 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012088rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012089 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12090 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12091 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12092
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012093resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12094 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12095 server.
12096
12097 Available options:
12098
12099 * allow-dup-ip
12100 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12101 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12102 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12103 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12104 For such case, simply enable this option.
12105 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12106
12107 * prevent-dup-ip
12108 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12109 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12110 same fqdn.
12111 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12112
12113 Example:
12114 backend b_myapp
12115 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12116 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12117 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12118
12119 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12120 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12121 it
12122 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12123 different address
12124
12125 Default value: not set
12126
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012127resolve-prefer <family>
12128 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12129 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12130 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12131 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12132
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012133 Default value: ipv6
12134
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012135 Example:
12136
12137 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012138
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012139resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12140 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12141 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012142 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012143 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12144 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012145 configured network, another address is selected.
12146
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012147 Example:
12148
12149 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012150
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012151resolvers <id>
12152 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12153 hostname.
12154
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012155 Example:
12156
12157 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012158
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012159 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012160
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012161send-proxy
12162 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12163 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12164 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12165 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012166 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12167 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12168 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12169 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12170 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12171 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12172 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12173 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12174 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12175 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012176 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12177 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012178
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012179send-proxy-v2
12180 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12181 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12182 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12183 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012184 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12185 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12186 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12187 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012188
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012189proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12190 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12191 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012192 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12193 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012194 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12195 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012196 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012197
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012198send-proxy-v2-ssl
12199 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12200 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12201 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12202 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12203 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12204 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12205 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012206 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12207 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012208
12209send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12210 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12211 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12212 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12213 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12214 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12215 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12216 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12217 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012218 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12219 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012221slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012222 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12223 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12224 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12225 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12226 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12227 parameters :
12228
12229 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12230 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12231
12232 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12233 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12234 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12235 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12236
12237 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12238 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12239 seen as failed.
12240
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012241sni <expression>
12242 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12243 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12244 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12245 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012246 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12247 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012248 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012249 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12250 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012251
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012252source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012253source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012254source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012255 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12256 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12257 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12258 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12259
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012260 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12261 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12262 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12263 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12264 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12265 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12266 server.
12267
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012268 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12269 specifying the source address without port(s).
12270
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012271ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012272 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12273 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12274 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12275 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12276 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12277 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012278 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12279 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012280
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012281ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12282 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12283 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12284 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12285
12286ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12287 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12288 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12289 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12290
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012291ssl-reuse
12292 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12293 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12294 default value.
12295 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12296 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12297
12298stick
12299 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12300 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12301 default value.
12302 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12303 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012304
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012305tcp-ut <delay>
12306 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12307 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12308 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012309 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012310 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12311 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12312 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12313 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12314 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12315 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12316 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12317 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12318 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012320track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012321 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12322 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12323 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12324 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012325 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12326
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012327tls-tickets
12328 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12329 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12330 default value.
12331 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12332 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012333
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012334verify [none|required]
12335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012336 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012337 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12338 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012339 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012340 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12341 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12342 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12343 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12344 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12345 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12346 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12347 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012348
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012349verifyhost <hostname>
12350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012351 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12352 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12353 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12354 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12355 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12356 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12357 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12358 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012359
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012360weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012361 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12362 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12363 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012364 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12365 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12366 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12367 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12368 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12369 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012370
12371
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123725.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12373-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012374
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012375HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12376using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12377configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012378This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12379can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12380workload.
12381This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12382resolution at run time.
12383Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12384carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12385
12386
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123875.3.1. Global overview
12388----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012389
12390As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12391different steps of the process life:
12392
12393 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12394 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12395 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12396
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012397 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12398 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012399
12400A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12401 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12402 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12403 resolution to know this new IP.
12404
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012405When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012406HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012407SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12408from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12409will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12410will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012411
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012412A few things important to notice:
12413 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12414 first valid response.
12415
12416 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12417 servers return an error.
12418
12419
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124205.3.2. The resolvers section
12421----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012422
12423This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012424HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12425contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012426
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012427When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12428uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12429is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12430answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12431
12432When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012433used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012434
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012435 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12436 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12437 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012438
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012439 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12440 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012441
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012442 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12443 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12444 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012445
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012446For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12447following scenarios are possible:
12448
12449 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12450 ignored
12451
12452 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12453 applied
12454
12455 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12456 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12457
12458 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12459 retries the query with a new type
12460
12461 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12462 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012463
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012464As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12465a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012466<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012467
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012468
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012469resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012470 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012471
12472A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12473
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012474accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012475 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012476 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012477 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12478 by RFC 6891)
12479
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012480 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12481
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012482nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12483 DNS server description:
12484 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12485 <ip> : IP address of the server
12486 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12487
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012488parse-resolv-conf
12489 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12490 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12491 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12492
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012493hold <status> <period>
12494 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12495 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012496 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012497 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012498 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12499 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12500 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12501
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012502 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012503
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012504resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012505 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12506 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12507 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12508
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012509resolve_retries <nb>
12510 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12511 giving up.
12512 Default value: 3
12513
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012514 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12515 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12516 type.
12517
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012518timeout <event> <time>
12519 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12520 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12521 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012522 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12523 other time applied.
12524 Default value: 1s
12525 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12526 have been received.
12527 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012528 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12529 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12530
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012531 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012532
12533 resolvers mydns
12534 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12535 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012536 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012537 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012538 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012539 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012540 hold other 30s
12541 hold refused 30s
12542 hold nx 30s
12543 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012544 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012545 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012546
12547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125486. HTTP header manipulation
12549---------------------------
12550
12551In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12552response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12553request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12554which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012555against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012556
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012557If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12558to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12559but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12560HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12561stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12562because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12563a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12564still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012566This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12567in section 4.2 :
12568
12569 - reqadd <string>
12570 - reqallow <search>
12571 - reqiallow <search>
12572 - reqdel <search>
12573 - reqidel <search>
12574 - reqdeny <search>
12575 - reqideny <search>
12576 - reqpass <search>
12577 - reqipass <search>
12578 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12579 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12580 - reqtarpit <search>
12581 - reqitarpit <search>
12582 - rspadd <string>
12583 - rspdel <search>
12584 - rspidel <search>
12585 - rspdeny <search>
12586 - rspideny <search>
12587 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12588 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12589
12590With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12591is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12592parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12593prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12594Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12595
12596 \t for a tab
12597 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12598 \n for a new line (LF)
12599 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12600 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12601 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12602 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12603 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12604
12605The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12606portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12607above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12608regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
126099 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12610is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12611
12612The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12613after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12614
12615Notes related to these keywords :
12616---------------------------------
12617 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12618 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12619 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12620
12621 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12622 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12623 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12624
12625 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12626 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12627 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12628 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12629 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12630
12631 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12632 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12633 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12634 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12635 useless headers before adding new ones.
12636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012637 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012638 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12639
12640 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12641 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12642 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12643
12644 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12645 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012646 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012647
12648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126497. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12650----------------------------------
12651
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012652HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012653client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12654The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12655these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12656but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12657data called patterns.
12658
12659
126607.1. ACL basics
12661---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012662
12663The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12664content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12665from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12666simple :
12667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012668 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012669 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012670 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12671 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012673The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12674adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012675
12676In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012678 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012679
12680This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12681Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12682and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012683an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12684conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12685as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12686are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012687
12688ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12689'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12690which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12691
12692There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12693performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012695The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12696specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12697this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012698methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12699ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012700
12701Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12702 - boolean
12703 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12704 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12705 - string
12706 - data block
12707
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012708Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12709converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12710would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12711The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12712which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12713
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012714Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12715keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12716fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12717which are summarized in the table below :
12718
12719 +---------------------+-----------------+
12720 | Sample or converter | Default |
12721 | output type | matching method |
12722 +---------------------+-----------------+
12723 | boolean | bool |
12724 +---------------------+-----------------+
12725 | integer | int |
12726 +---------------------+-----------------+
12727 | ip | ip |
12728 +---------------------+-----------------+
12729 | string | str |
12730 +---------------------+-----------------+
12731 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12732 +---------------------+-----------------+
12733
12734Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12735matching method, see below.
12736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012737The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12738 - boolean
12739 - integer or integer range
12740 - IP address / network
12741 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12742 - regular expression
12743 - hex block
12744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012745The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12746
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012747 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12748 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012749 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012750 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012751 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012752 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012753 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012755The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12756read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12757if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12758lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12759will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12760beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12761a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12762lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12763exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12764
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012765The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12766parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12767ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12768a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12769check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12770
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012771The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12772socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12773file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012775Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12776loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12777
12778 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12779
12780In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12781the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12782case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12783as well.
12784
12785The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12786sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12787do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12788methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12789is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012790obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012791followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12792default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12793that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12794string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12795
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012796The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12797By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12798string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12799resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12800server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12801waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12802flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12803function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012805There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12806sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12807be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012808
12809 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12810 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012811 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12812 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12813 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12814 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012815
12816 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12817 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012818 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012819
12820 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012822
12823 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012824 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012825
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012826 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012827 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12828
12829 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12830 binary or string samples.
12831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012832 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12833 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012835 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12836 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12837 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012839 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12840 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012842 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12843 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012845 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12846 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012848 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12849 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012850 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012852 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12853 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12854 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012855
12856For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12857request, it is possible to do :
12858
12859 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12860
12861In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12862buffer, one would use the following acl :
12863
12864 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12865
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012866On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12867possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12868
12869 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012871All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12872criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12873method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12874to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12875criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12876the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012878If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012879the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12880For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012882 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12883 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12884 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12885 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012886
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012887
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012888The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12889types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12890combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12891brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12892default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012894 +-------------------------------------------------+
12895 | Input sample type |
12896 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012897 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012898 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12899 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12900 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012901 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012902 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012903 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012904 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012905 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012906 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012907 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012908 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012909 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012910 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012911 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012912 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012913 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012914 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012915 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012916 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012917 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012919 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012920 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012921 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012922 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12923 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12924 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012925
12926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129277.1.1. Matching booleans
12928------------------------
12929
12930In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12931Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12932When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12933that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12934
12935Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12936return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12937"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12938
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129407.1.2. Matching integers
12941------------------------
12942
12943Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12944enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12945to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12946
12947Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12948matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12949lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012950
12951For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12952unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12953representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12954
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012955As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12956two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12957instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12958ranges and operators.
12959
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012960For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012961operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12962Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12963of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012965Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012966
12967 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12968 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12969 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12970 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12971 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012973For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012974
12975 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12976
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012977This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12978
12979 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12980
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129827.1.3. Matching strings
12983-----------------------
12984
12985String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12986different forms :
12987
12988 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012989 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012990
12991 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012992 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012993
12994 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12995 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12996
12997 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12998 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12999
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013000 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13002 matches.
13003
13004 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13005 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13006 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013007
13008String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13009exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13010characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13011string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13012to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013013before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013014
13015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130167.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13017---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013018
13019Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13020they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13021possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13022passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13023the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013024the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13025match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013026
13027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130287.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13029-------------------------------------
13030
13031It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13032not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13033a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13034to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13035digits may be used upper or lower case.
13036
13037Example :
13038 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13039 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13040
13041
130427.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13043---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013044
13045IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13046netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13047within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013048host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013049difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13050at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13051does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13052parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013053
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013054The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13055abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13056
13057 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13058 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13059 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13060 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13061 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13062 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13063 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13064 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13065
13066Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13067192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13068
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013069IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13070Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13071trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13072IPv6 patterns.
13073
13074HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13075following situations :
13076 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13077 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13078 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13079 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13080 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13081 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13082 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13083 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13084 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13085 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013087
130887.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13089----------------------------------
13090
13091Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13092combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13093
13094 - AND (implicit)
13095 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13096 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013098A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013100 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013102Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13103indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013105For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13106"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13107requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13108is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13109
13110 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013111 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13112 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13113 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013114
13115To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13116and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13117
13118 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13119 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13120 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13121 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13122
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013123 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13125 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13126 use_backend www if host_www
13127
13128It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13129expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13130be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13131the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13132
13133 The following rule :
13134
13135 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013136 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013137
13138 Can also be written that way :
13139
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013140 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013141
13142It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13143to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13144simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13145sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13146good use is the following :
13147
13148 With named ACLs :
13149
13150 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13151 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13152 monitor fail if site_dead
13153
13154 With anonymous ACLs :
13155
13156 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13157
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013158See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13159keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013160
13161
131627.3. Fetching samples
13163---------------------
13164
13165Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13166against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13167sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13168ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13169of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13170available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13171
13172This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13173Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13174compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13175deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13176
13177The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13178matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13179method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13180indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13181
13182As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13183when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13184mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13185the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13186ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13187
13188Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13189multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13190when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013191incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13192are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013193is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13194all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13195
13196Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13197 - name
13198 - name(arg1)
13199 - name(arg1,arg2)
13200
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013201
132027.3.1. Converters
13203-----------------
13204
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013205Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13206of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13207is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13208was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013209has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013210unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13211
13212These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13213sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13214the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013215support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013216
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013217A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13218support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13219supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13220(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13221bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013223The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013224
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001322551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13226 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13227 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13228 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13229 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13230 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13231
13232 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013233 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13234 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013235 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13236 frontend http-in
13237 bind *:8081
13238 default_backend servers
13239 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13240 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13241
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013242add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013243 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013244 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013245 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13246 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013247 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013248 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13249 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13250 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13251 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013252 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013253 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013254
13255and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013256 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013257 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013258 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13259 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013260 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013261 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13262 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13263 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13264 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013265 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013266 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013267
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013268b64dec
13269 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13270 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13271
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013272base64
13273 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013274 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013275 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13276
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013277bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013278 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013279 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013280 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013281 presence of a flag).
13282
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013283bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13284 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13285 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013286 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013287
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013288concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13289 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13290 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13291 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13292 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13293 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13294 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13295 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13296 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13297 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13298 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13299 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13300 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13301 delimitors.
13302
13303 Example:
13304 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13305 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13306 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13307 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13308
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013309cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013310 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13311 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013312
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013313crc32([<avalanche>])
13314 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13315 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13316 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13317 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13318 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13319 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13320 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13321 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13322 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13323 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013324 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13325
13326crc32c([<avalanche>])
13327 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13328 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13329 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13330 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13331 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13332 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13333 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13334 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013335
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013336da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013337 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13338 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13339 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13340 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013341 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013342 configuration language.
13343
13344 Example:
13345 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013346 bind *:8881
13347 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013348 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013349
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013350debug
13351 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13352 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13353 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13354
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013355div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013356 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13357 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013358 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013359 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13360 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013361 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013362 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13363 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13364 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13365 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013366 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013367 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013368
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013369djb2([<avalanche>])
13370 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13371 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13372 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13373 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13374 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13375 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13376 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013377 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13378 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013379
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013380even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013381 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013382 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13383
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013384field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13385 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13386 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13387 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13388 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13389 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13390 fields.
13391
13392 Example :
13393 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13394 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13395 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13396 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13397 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013398
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013399hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013400 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013401 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013402 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013403 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013404
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013405hex2i
13406 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13407 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13408
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013409http_date([<offset>])
13410 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13411 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13412 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13413 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13414 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13415 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013416
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013417in_table(<table>)
13418 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13419 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13420 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013421 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013422 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13423
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013424ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13425 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013426 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013427 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13428 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13429 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13430 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13431 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013432
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013433json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013434 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013435 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013436 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013437 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13438 of errors:
13439 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13440 bytes, ...)
13441 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13442 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13443
13444 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13445 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13446 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13447 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13448 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13449 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013450 - "ascii" : never fails;
13451 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13452 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013453 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013454 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013455 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13456 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13457
13458 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013459 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013460
13461 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013462 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013463 capture request header user-agent len 150
13464 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013465
13466 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13467 GET / HTTP/1.0
13468 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13469
13470 Output log:
13471 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13472
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013473language(<value>[,<default>])
13474 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13475 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13476 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13477 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13478 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13479 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13480 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13481 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13482 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013483 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013484 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13485 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013486
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013487 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013488
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013489 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13490 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013491
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013492 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13493 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13494 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13495 use_backend spanish if es
13496 use_backend french if fr
13497 use_backend english if en
13498 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013499
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013500length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013501 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13502 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13503 type. The result is of type integer.
13504
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013505lower
13506 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13507 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13508 type. The result is of type string.
13509
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013510ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13511 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13512 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13513 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13514 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13515 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13516 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13517
13518 Example :
13519
13520 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013521 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013522 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13523
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013524map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13525map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13526map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13527 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13528 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13529 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13530 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13531 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13532 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13533 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13534 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013535
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013536 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13537 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13538 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013539
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013540 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013541 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013542
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013543 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13544 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13545 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13546 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013547 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13548 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013549 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13550 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13551 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13552 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13553 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13554 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13555 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13556 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013557 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13558 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13559 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013560 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13561 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13562 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13563 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13564 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013565
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013566 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13567 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13568 the corresponding match text.
13569
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013570 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13571 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13572 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13573 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13574 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013575
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013576 Example :
13577
13578 # this is a comment and is ignored
13579 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13580 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13581 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13582 | | | `---------- value
13583 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13584 | `---------------------------- key
13585 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13586
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013587mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013588 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13589 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013590 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013591 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013592 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013593 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13594 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13595 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13596 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013597 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013598 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013599
13600mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013601 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013602 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13603 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013604 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013605 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013606 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013607 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13608 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13609 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13610 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013611 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013612 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013613
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013614nbsrv
13615 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13616 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13617 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13618 map lookup.
13619
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013620neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013621 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13622 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13623 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13624 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013625
13626not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013627 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013628 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013629 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013630 absence of a flag).
13631
13632odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013633 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013634 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13635
13636or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013637 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013638 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013639 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13640 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013641 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013642 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13643 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13644 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13645 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013646 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013647 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013648
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013649regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013650 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13651 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13652 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13653 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13654 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13655 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13656 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13657 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13658 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13659 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013660 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13661 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13662 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13663 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013664
13665 Example :
13666
13667 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13668 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13669 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13670 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13671
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013672capture-req(<id>)
13673 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13674 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13675
13676 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013677 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13678 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013679
13680capture-res(<id>)
13681 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13682 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13683
13684 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013685 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13686 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013687
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013688sdbm([<avalanche>])
13689 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13690 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13691 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13692 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13693 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13694 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13695 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013696 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13697 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013698
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013699set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013700 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13701 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13702 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013703 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013704 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13705 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013706 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013707 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13708 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013709 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013710 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013711
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013712sha1
13713 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13714 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13715
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013716strcmp(<var>)
13717 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13718 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13719 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13720 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13721 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13722 shorter).
13723
13724 Example :
13725
13726 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13727 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13728 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13729
13730
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013731sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013732 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13733 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013734 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013735 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13736 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013737 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013738 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13739 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013740 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013741 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13742 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013743 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013744 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013745
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013746table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13747 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13748 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13749 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13750 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13751 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13752 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13753
13754
13755table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13756 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13757 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13758 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13759 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13760 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13761 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13762
13763table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13764 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13765 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013766 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013767 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13768 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13769
13770table_conn_cur(<table>)
13771 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13772 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13773 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13774 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13775 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13776
13777table_conn_rate(<table>)
13778 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13779 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13780 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13781 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13782 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13783
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013784table_gpt0(<table>)
13785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13787 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13788 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13789 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13790
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013791table_gpc0(<table>)
13792 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13793 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13794 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13795 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13796 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13797
13798table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13799 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13800 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13801 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13802 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13803 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13804 sample fetch keyword.
13805
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013806table_gpc1(<table>)
13807 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13808 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13809 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13810 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13811 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13812
13813table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13814 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13815 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13816 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13817 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13818 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13819 sample fetch keyword.
13820
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013821table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13822 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13823 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013824 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013825 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13826 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13827
13828table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13829 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13830 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13831 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13832 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13833 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13834 keyword.
13835
13836table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13837 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13838 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013839 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013840 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13841 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13842
13843table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13844 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13845 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13846 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13847 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13848 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13849 keyword.
13850
13851table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13852 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13853 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013854 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013855 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13856 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13857 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13858 keyword.
13859
13860table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13861 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13862 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013863 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013864 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13865 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13866 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13867 keyword.
13868
13869table_server_id(<table>)
13870 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13871 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13872 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13873 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13874 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13875 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13876
13877table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13878 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13879 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013880 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013881 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13882 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13883 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13884 keyword.
13885
13886table_sess_rate(<table>)
13887 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13888 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13889 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13890 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13891 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13892 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13893 keyword.
13894
13895table_trackers(<table>)
13896 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13897 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13898 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13899 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13900 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13901 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13902 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13903 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13904 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13905 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13906
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013907upper
13908 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13909 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13910 type. The result is of type string.
13911
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013912url_dec
13913 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13914 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13915
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013916unset-var(<var name>)
13917 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13918 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13919 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13920 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13921 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13922 response),
13923 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13924 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13925 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13926 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13927
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013928utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13929 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13930 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13931 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13932 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13933 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13934 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13935
13936 Example :
13937
13938 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013939 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013940 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13941
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013942word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13943 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13944 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13945 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13946 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13947 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13948
13949 Example :
13950 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13951 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13952 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13953 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13954 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013955
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013956wt6([<avalanche>])
13957 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13958 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13959 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13960 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13961 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13962 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13963 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013964 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13965 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013966
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013967xor(<value>)
13968 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013969 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013970 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013971 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013972 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013973 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13974 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013975 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013976 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13977 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013978 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013979 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013980
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013981xxh32([<seed>])
13982 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13983 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13984 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13985 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13986 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13987 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13988 as cryptographically secure.
13989
13990xxh64([<seed>])
13991 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13992 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13993 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13994 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13995 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13996 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13997 as cryptographically secure.
13998
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013999
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140007.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014001--------------------------------------------
14002
14003A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14004not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14005"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14006The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14007
14008always_false : boolean
14009 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14010 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14011
14012always_true : boolean
14013 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14014 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14015
14016avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014017 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14019 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14020 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14021 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14022 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14023 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14024 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14025 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14026 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14027 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14028 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14029 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14030 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014032be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014033 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14034 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14035 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14036 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014037 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14038
14039be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14040 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14041 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14042 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14043 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14044 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014045 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14046 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014047
14048 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14049 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14050 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014052be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14053 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14054 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14055 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014056 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014057 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14058 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014059
14060 Example :
14061 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14062 backend dynamic
14063 mode http
14064 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14065 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014066
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014067bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014068 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14069 of the string.
14070
14071bool(<bool>) : bool
14072 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14073 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014075connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14076 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014077 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014078 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14079 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014080
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014081 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014082 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014083 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14084
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014085 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14086 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014087
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014088 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014089 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014090 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014091 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014092 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014093 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014094 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014095
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014096 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14097 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014098 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014099 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014100
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014101cpu_calls : integer
14102 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14103 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14104 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14105 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14106 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14107 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14108
14109cpu_ns_avg : integer
14110 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14111 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14112 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14113 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14114 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14115 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14116 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14117 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14118 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14119 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14120 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14121
14122cpu_ns_tot : integer
14123 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14124 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14125 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14126 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14127 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14128 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14129 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14130 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14131 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14132 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14133 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14134 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14135 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14136
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014137date([<offset>]) : integer
14138 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14139 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14140 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14141 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014142 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14143
14144 Example :
14145
14146 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14147 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014148
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014149date_us : integer
14150 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14151 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14152 from the same timeval structure.
14153
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014154distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14155 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14156 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14157 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14158 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14159 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14160 list of supported tokens.
14161
14162distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14163 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14164 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14165 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14166 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14167 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14168 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14169 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14170 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14171 supported tokens.
14172
14173 Example :
14174 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14175 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14176 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14177 # send large files to the big farm
14178 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14179
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014180env(<name>) : string
14181 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14182 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14183 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14184 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14185 certain way.
14186
14187 Examples :
14188 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14189 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14190
14191 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14192 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014194fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14195 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014196 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14197 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014198 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14199 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014200 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014201 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14202 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014203
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014204fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14205 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14206 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14207 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014209fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14210 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14211 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14212 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14213 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14214 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14215 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14216 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14217 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014218
14219 Example :
14220 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14221 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14222 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14223 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14224 frontend mail
14225 bind :25
14226 mode tcp
14227 maxconn 100
14228 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14229 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14230 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14231 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014232
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014233hostname : string
14234 Returns the system hostname.
14235
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014236int(<integer>) : signed integer
14237 Returns a signed integer.
14238
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014239ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14240 Returns an ipv4.
14241
14242ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14243 Returns an ipv6.
14244
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014245lat_ns_avg : integer
14246 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14247 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14248 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14249 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14250 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14251 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14252 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14253 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14254 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14255 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14256 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14257 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14258 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14259 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14260
14261lat_ns_tot : integer
14262 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14263 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14264 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14265 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14266 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14267 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14268 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14269 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14270 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14271 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14272 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14273 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14274 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14275 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14276 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14277 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14278 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14279 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14280 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14281
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014282meth(<method>) : method
14283 Returns a method.
14284
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014285nbproc : integer
14286 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14287 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14288 and debugging purposes.
14289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014290nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14291 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14292 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14293 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014294 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14295 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14296 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014297
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014298prio_class : integer
14299 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14300 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14301 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14302
14303prio_offset : integer
14304 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14305 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14306 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14307 set-priority-offset".
14308
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014309proc : integer
14310 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14311 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14312 debugging purposes.
14313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014314queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014315 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14316 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14317 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014318 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14319 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14320 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14321 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14322 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14323
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014324rand([<range>]) : integer
14325 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14326 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14327 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14328 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14329 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14332 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14333 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14334 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14335 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14336 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014337 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14338 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14339
14340srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14341 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14342 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14343 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14344 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14345 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14346 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14347 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14348
14349 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14350 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014351
14352srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14353 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14354 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14355 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014356 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014357 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14358 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14359 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14360
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014361srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14362 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14363 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14364 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14365 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14366 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14367 fetch methods.
14368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014369srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14370 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14371 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014372 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014373 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14374 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014375 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014376 overloading servers).
14377
14378 Example :
14379 # Redirect to a separate back
14380 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14381 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14382 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14383
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014384stopping : boolean
14385 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14386 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14387 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14388
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014389str(<string>) : string
14390 Returns a string.
14391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014392table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14393 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14394 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14395
14396table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14397 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14398 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14399 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14400
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014401thread : integer
14402 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14403 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14404 and debugging purposes.
14405
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014406var(<var-name>) : undefined
14407 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014408 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14409 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014410 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014411 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14412 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014413 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014414 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14415 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014416 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014417 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014418
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144197.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014420----------------------------------
14421
14422The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14423closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14424methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14425sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14426TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014427the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14428counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014429"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14430used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14431can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14432Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14433table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14434tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14435currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014436
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014437bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014438 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14439 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14440 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014442be_id : integer
14443 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14444 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14445
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014446be_name : string
14447 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14448 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450dst : ip
14451 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14452 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14453 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14454 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014455 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14456 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14457 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14458 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14459 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14460 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014461
14462dst_conn : integer
14463 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14464 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14465 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14466 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14467 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14468 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14469 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14470 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014471
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014472dst_is_local : boolean
14473 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14474 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14475 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14476 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014477 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014478 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14479 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14480 it only once per connection.
14481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014482dst_port : integer
14483 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14484 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14485 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14486 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14487 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14488 an HTTP header.
14489
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014490fc_http_major : integer
14491 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14492 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14493 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14494
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014495fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14496 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14497 header.
14498
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014499fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14500 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14501 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14502 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14503 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14504 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14505 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14506
14507fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14508 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14509 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14510 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14511 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14512 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14513 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14514
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014515fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14516 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14517 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14518 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14519 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14520
14521fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14522 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14523 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14524 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14525 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14526
14527fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14528 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14529 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14530 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14531 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14532
14533fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14534 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14535 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14536 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14537 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14538
14539fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14540 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14541 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14542 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14543 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14544
14545fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14546 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14547 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14548 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14549 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14550
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014551fe_defbe : string
14552 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14553 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555fe_id : integer
14556 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014557 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014558 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14559
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014560fe_name : string
14561 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14562 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14563 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14564
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014565sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014566sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14567sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14568sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014569 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14570 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14571 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14572
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014573sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014574sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14575sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14576sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014577 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14578 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14579 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14580
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014581sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014582sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14583sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14584sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014585 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14586 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014587 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14588 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14589 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014590
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014591 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014592 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14593 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014594 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14595 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14596 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014597 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14598 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14599
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014600sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14601sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14602sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14603sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14604 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14605 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14606 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14607 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14608 when a first ACL was verified.
14609
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014610sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014611sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14612sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14613sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014614 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014615 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14616
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014617sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014618sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14619sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14620sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014621 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14622 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14623 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14624
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014625sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014626sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14627sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14628sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014629 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14630 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14631 See also src_conn_rate.
14632
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014633sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014634sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14635sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14636sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014637 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014638 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014639
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014640sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14641sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14642sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14643sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14644 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14645 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14646
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014647sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14648sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14649sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14650sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14651 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14652 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14653
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014654sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014655sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14656sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14657sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014658 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14659 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14660 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014661 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14662 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14663 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014664
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014665sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14666sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14667sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14668sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14669 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14670 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14671 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14672 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14673 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14674 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14675
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014676sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014677sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14678sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14679sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014680 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014681 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14682 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14683
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014684sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014685sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14686sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14687sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014688 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14689 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14690 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14691 src_http_err_rate.
14692
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014693sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014694sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14695sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14696sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014697 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014698 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14699 src_http_req_cnt.
14700
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014701sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014702sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14703sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14704sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014705 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14706 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14707 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14708 src_http_req_rate.
14709
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014710sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014711sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14712sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14713sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014714 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014715 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14716 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14717 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14718 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014719
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014720 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014721 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14722 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014723 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14724
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014725sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14726sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14727sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14728sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14729 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14730 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14731 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14732 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14733 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14734
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014735sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014736sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14737sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14738sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014739 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14740 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14741 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014742
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014743sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014744sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14745sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14746sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014747 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14748 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14749 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014750
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014751sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014752sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14753sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14754sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014755 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014756 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14757 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14758 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014759 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014760 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14761
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014762sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014763sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14764sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14765sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014766 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14767 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14768 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14769 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14770 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014771 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014772
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014773sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014774sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14775sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14776sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014777 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14778 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14779 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14780
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014781sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014782sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14783sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14784sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014785 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14786 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014787 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014788 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14789 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014790 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14791 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14792 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014794so_id : integer
14795 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14796 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14797 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014799src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014800 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14802 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14803 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014804 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14805 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14806 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014807 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14808 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14809 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14810 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14811 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14812 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14813 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014814
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014815 Example:
14816 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14817 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14820 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14821 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14822 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014823 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14826 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14827 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014828 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014829 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14832 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14833 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14834 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14835 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14836 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14837 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014838
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014839 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014840 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14841 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14842 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14843 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014844 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014845 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14846 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14847
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014848src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14849 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14850 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14851 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14852 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14853 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14854 was verified.
14855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014856src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014857 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014858 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014859 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014860 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014862src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014863 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014864 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14865 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014866 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014868src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14869 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14870 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14871 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014872 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014875 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014877 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014878 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014879
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014880src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14881 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14882 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14883 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14884 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14885
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014886src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14887 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14888 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14889 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14890 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014893 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014894 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014895 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14896 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014897 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14898 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14899 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014900
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014901src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14902 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14903 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14904 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14905 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14906 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14907 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14908 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014910src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014911 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014913 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014914 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014915 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014917src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14918 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14919 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14920 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14921 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014922 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014925 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014926 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14927 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014928 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14931 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14932 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14933 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014934 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014935 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014937src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14938 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14939 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14940 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014941 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014942 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14943 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014944
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014945 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014946 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014947 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014948 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014949
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014950src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14951 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14952 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14953 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14954 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14955 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14956 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14957
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014958src_is_local : boolean
14959 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14960 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14961 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14962 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014963 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014964 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14965 once per connection.
14966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014968 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14969 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14970 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14971 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14972 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014974src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014975 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14976 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14977 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14978 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14979 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014981src_port : integer
14982 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14983 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14984 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14985 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014987src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014988 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014989 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14990 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14991 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014992 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014994src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14995 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14996 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14997 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14998 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014999 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015001src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15002 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15003 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15004 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15005 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15006 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15007 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15008 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15009 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015010
15011 Example :
15012 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15013 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15014 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15015 listen ssh
15016 bind :22
15017 mode tcp
15018 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015019 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015020 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015021 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015023srv_id : integer
15024 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15025 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15026 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015027
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150287.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015029----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15032closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15033when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15034usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015035future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015036
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001503751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15038 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15039 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15040 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15041 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15042 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15043
15044 Example :
15045 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15046 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15047 # the request.
15048 frontend http-in
15049 bind *:8081
15050 default_backend servers
15051 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15052 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15053
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015054ssl_bc : boolean
15055 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15056 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15057 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15058
15059ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15060 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15061 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15062
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015063ssl_bc_alpn : string
15064 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15065 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15066 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15067 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15068 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15069 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15070 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15071 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15072 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15073
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015074ssl_bc_cipher : string
15075 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15076 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15077
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015078ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15079 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15080 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15081 session or a TLS ticket.
15082
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015083ssl_bc_npn : string
15084 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15085 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15086 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15087 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15088 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15089 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15090 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15091 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15092
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015093ssl_bc_protocol : string
15094 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15095 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15096
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015097ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015098 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015099 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15100 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015101
15102ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15103 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15104 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15105 if session was reused or not.
15106
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015107ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15108 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15109 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15110 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15111 BoringSSL.
15112
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015113ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15114 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15115 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015117ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15118 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15119 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15120 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15121 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15122 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015124ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15125 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15126 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15127 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15128 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015129
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015130ssl_c_der : binary
15131 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15132 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15133 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015135ssl_c_err : integer
15136 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15137 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15138 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15139 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15140 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015142ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15143 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15144 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15145 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15146 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15147 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15148 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15149 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15150 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015152ssl_c_key_alg : string
15153 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15154 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15155 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015157ssl_c_notafter : string
15158 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15159 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15160 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162ssl_c_notbefore : string
15163 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15164 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15165 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015167ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15168 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15169 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15170 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15171 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15172 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15173 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15174 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15175 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015177ssl_c_serial : binary
15178 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15179 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15180 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15183 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15184 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15185 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015186 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15187 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15188
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015189 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015190 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015192ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15193 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15194 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15195 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015197ssl_c_used : boolean
15198 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15199 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015201ssl_c_verify : integer
15202 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15203 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15204 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15205 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015207ssl_c_version : integer
15208 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15209 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015210
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015211ssl_f_der : binary
15212 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15213 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15214 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15217 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15218 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15219 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15220 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015221 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015222 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15223 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15224 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015226ssl_f_key_alg : string
15227 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15228 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15229 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231ssl_f_notafter : string
15232 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15233 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15234 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236ssl_f_notbefore : string
15237 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15238 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15239 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015241ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15242 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15243 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15244 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15245 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15246 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15247 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15248 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15249 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251ssl_f_serial : binary
15252 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15253 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15254 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015255
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015256ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15257 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15258 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15259 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015261ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15262 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15263 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15264 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015266ssl_f_version : integer
15267 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15268 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15269
15270ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015271 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15272 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15273 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275 Example :
15276 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15277 listen http-https
15278 bind :80
15279 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15280 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15281
15282ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15283 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15284 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15285
15286ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015287 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15289 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15290 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15291 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15292 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15293 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15294 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15295 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015297ssl_fc_cipher : string
15298 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15299 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015300
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015301ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15302 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15303 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015304 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015305
15306ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15307 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15308 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015309 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015310
15311ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15312 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15313 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15314 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015315 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015316 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015317
15318ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15319 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15320 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015321 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015323ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015324 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15325 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015326 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15327 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15328 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15329 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015330
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015331ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15332 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15333 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15334 wait until the handshake happened.
15335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015336ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15337 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015338 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15339 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15340 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15341 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015342
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015343ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015344 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015345 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15346 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015348ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015349 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15351 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15352 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15353 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15354 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15355 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15356 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015358ssl_fc_protocol : string
15359 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15360 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015361
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015362ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015363 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015364 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15365 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015367ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15368 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15369 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15370 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15371 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015372
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015373ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15374 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15375 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15376 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15377 BoringSSL.
15378
15379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015380ssl_fc_sni : string
15381 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15382 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15383 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15384 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15385 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15386
15387 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15388 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15389 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015390 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15391 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015393 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015394 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15395 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015397ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15398 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15399 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015400
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015401
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154027.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015403------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015405Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15406sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15407only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15408For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15409be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15410can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15411sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15412for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15413content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015415payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015416 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015417 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15418 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015420payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15421 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015422 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015423 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015424
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015425req.hdrs : string
15426 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15427 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15428 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15429 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15430
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015431req.hdrs_bin : binary
15432 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15433 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15434 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15435 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15436 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15437 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15438
15439 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15440
15441 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15442 str: <int:length><bytes>
15443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015444req.len : integer
15445req_len : integer (deprecated)
15446 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15447 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15448 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15449 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15450 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15451 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15452 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15453 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015455req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15456 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015457 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15458 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15459 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15460 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462 ACL alternatives :
15463 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015465req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15466 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15467 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15468 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15469 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015471 ACL alternatives :
15472 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015476req.proto_http : boolean
15477req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15478 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15479 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15480 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15481 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15482 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15483 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15484 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486 Example:
15487 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15488 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15489 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015490 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15493rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15494 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15495 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15496 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15497 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15498 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15499 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15500 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15503 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15504 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15505 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15506 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15507 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509 ACL derivatives :
15510 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512 Example :
15513 listen tse-farm
15514 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15515 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15516 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15517 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15518 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15519 persist rdp-cookie
15520 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15521 # This is only useful makes sense if
15522 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15523 stick-table type string size 204800
15524 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15525 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15526 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015528 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15529 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15532rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15533 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15534 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15535 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15536 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538 ACL derivatives :
15539 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015540
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015541req.ssl_alpn : string
15542 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15543 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15544 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15545 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15546 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15547 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015548 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015549
15550 Examples :
15551 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15552 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15553 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015554 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015555 default_backend bk_default
15556
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015557req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15558 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15559 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015560 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15561 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15562 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15563 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15564 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015566req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15567req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15568 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15569 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15570 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15571 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15572 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15573 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15574 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576req.ssl_sni : string
15577req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15578 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15579 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15580 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15581 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15582 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15583 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15584 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15585 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15586 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15587 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15588 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15589 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591 ACL derivatives :
15592 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015594 Examples :
15595 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15596 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15597 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15598 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15599 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015600
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015601req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15602 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15603 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15604 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15605 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15606 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15607 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15608 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15609 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15610 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612req.ssl_ver : integer
15613req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15614 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15615 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15616 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15617 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15618 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15619 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15620 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015621 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624 ACL derivatives :
15625 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015626
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015627res.len : integer
15628 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15629 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15630 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15631 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15632 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15633 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15634 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15635 content inspection.
15636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15638 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015639 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15640 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15641 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15642 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015644res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15645 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15646 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15647 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15648 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015651
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015652res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15653rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15654 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15655 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15656 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15657 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15658 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15659 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15660 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015662wait_end : boolean
15663 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15664 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015665 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15667 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015668 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15670 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672 Examples :
15673 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15674 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15675 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15678 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15679 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15680 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15681 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15682 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15683 tcp-request content reject
15684
15685
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156867.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687--------------------------------------
15688
15689It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15690This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15691data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15692its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15693HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15694content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15695to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15696more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15697response are indexed.
15698
15699base : string
15700 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15701 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15702 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15703 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15704 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15705 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15706 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15707 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15708
15709 ACL derivatives :
15710 base : exact string match
15711 base_beg : prefix match
15712 base_dir : subdir match
15713 base_dom : domain match
15714 base_end : suffix match
15715 base_len : length match
15716 base_reg : regex match
15717 base_sub : substring match
15718
15719base32 : integer
15720 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15721 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15722 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015723 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15724 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15725 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726
15727base32+src : binary
15728 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15729 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15730 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15731 per-URL counters.
15732
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015733capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15734 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15735 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15736 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15737
15738capture.req.method : string
15739 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15740 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15741 because it's allocated.
15742
15743capture.req.uri : string
15744 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15745 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15746 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15747 allocated.
15748
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015749capture.req.ver : string
15750 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15751 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15752 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15753
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015754capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15755 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15756 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15757 The first entry is an index of 0.
15758 See also: "capture response header"
15759
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015760capture.res.ver : string
15761 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15762 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15763 persistent flag.
15764
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015765req.body : binary
15766 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15767 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15768 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15769 the first chunk is analyzed.
15770
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015771req.body_param([<name>) : string
15772 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15773 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15774 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15775 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15776 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15777 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15778 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15779 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15780 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15781 given.
15782
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015783req.body_len : integer
15784 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15785 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15786 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15787 "option http-buffer-request".
15788
15789req.body_size : integer
15790 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15791 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15792 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15793 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15794 "option http-buffer-request".
15795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796req.cook([<name>]) : string
15797cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15798 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15799 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15800 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15801 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15802 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15803 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15804 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15805 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15806
15807 ACL derivatives :
15808 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15809 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15810 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15811 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15812 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15813 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15814 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15815 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15818cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15819 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15820 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015822req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15823cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15824 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15825 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15826 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15827 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015829cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15830 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15831 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15832 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15833 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015834 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015835 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15836 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15837 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15838 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015840hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15841 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15842 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15843 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15844 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015845 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015847req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15848 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15849 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15850 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15851 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15852 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15853 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15854 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15855 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015857req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15858 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15859 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15860 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15861 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15864 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15865 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15866 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15867 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15868 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15869 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15870 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15871 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015872 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015873 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015874 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876 ACL derivatives :
15877 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15878 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15879 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15880 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15881 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15882 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15883 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15884 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15885
15886req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15887hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15888 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15889 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15890 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15891 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15892 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15893 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15894 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15895 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15896 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15897
15898req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15899hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15900 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15901 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15902 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15903 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15904 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015905 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15907 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15908
15909req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15910hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15911 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15912 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15913 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15914 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15915 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15916 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15917 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15918
15919http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15920 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15921 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15922 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15923 basic auth is supported.
15924
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015925http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15926 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15927 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15928 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15929 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015930 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15931 basic auth is supported.
15932
15933 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015934 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15935 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15936 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15937 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938
15939http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015940 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15941 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15943 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015945method : integer + string
15946 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15947 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15948 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15949 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15950 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15951 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15952 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954 ACL derivatives :
15955 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957 Example :
15958 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15959 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15960 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015962path : string
15963 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15964 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15965 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15966 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15967 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015968 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015971 ACL derivatives :
15972 path : exact string match
15973 path_beg : prefix match
15974 path_dir : subdir match
15975 path_dom : domain match
15976 path_end : suffix match
15977 path_len : length match
15978 path_reg : regex match
15979 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015980
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015981query : string
15982 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15983 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15984 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15985 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015986 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015987 which stops before the question mark.
15988
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015989req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15990 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15991 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15992 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15993 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015995req.ver : string
15996req_ver : string (deprecated)
15997 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15998 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15999 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016001 ACL derivatives :
16002 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016004res.comp : boolean
16005 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16006 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16007 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009res.comp_algo : string
16010 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16011 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16012 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014res.cook([<name>]) : string
16015scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16016 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16017 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16018 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016020 ACL derivatives :
16021 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16024scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16025 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16026 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16027 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016029res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16030scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16031 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16032 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16033 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16036 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16037 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16038 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16039 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16040 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16041 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16042 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16043 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16044 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016046res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16047 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16048 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16049 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16050 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16051 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016053res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16054shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16055 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16056 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16057 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16058 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16059 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16060 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16061 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16062 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064 ACL derivatives :
16065 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16066 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16067 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16068 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16069 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16070 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16071 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16072 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16073
16074res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16075shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16076 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16077 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16078 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16079 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16080 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016082res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16083shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16084 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16085 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16086 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16087 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16088 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16089 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016090
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016091res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16092 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16093 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16094 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16095 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016097res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16098shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16099 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16100 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16101 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16102 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16103 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16104 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106res.ver : string
16107resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16108 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16109 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111 ACL derivatives :
16112 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016114set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16115 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16116 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016117 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16121 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016123status : integer
16124 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16125 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16126 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016127
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016128unique-id : string
16129 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16130 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16131 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16132 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16133 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16134 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136url : string
16137 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16138 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16139 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16140 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16141 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16142 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16143 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145 ACL derivatives :
16146 url : exact string match
16147 url_beg : prefix match
16148 url_dir : subdir match
16149 url_dom : domain match
16150 url_end : suffix match
16151 url_len : length match
16152 url_reg : regex match
16153 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155url_ip : ip
16156 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16157 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16158 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16159 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16160 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16161 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16162 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016164url_port : integer
16165 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16166 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16167 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16168 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016169
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016170urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16171url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016172 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16173 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016174 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16175 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16176 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16177 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16179 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016180 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16181 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183 ACL derivatives :
16184 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16185 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16186 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16187 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16188 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16189 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16190 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16191 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016192
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016194 Example :
16195 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16196 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16197 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16198 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016199
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016200urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016201 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16202 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16203 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016204
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016205url32 : integer
16206 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16207 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16208 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16209 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16210 is an unsigned integer.
16211
16212url32+src : binary
16213 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16214 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16215 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16216
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162187.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016219---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016221Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16222every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016223order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016225ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16226---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016227FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016228HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016229HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16230HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016231HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16232HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16233HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16234HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16235LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016236METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016237METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016238METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16239METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16240METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16241METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016242METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016243METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016244RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016245REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016246TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016247WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16248---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016249
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162518. Logging
16252----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016253
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016254One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16255provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16256very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16257provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16258state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016259to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016260headers.
16261
16262In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16263about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16264send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16265
16266 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16267 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16268 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16269 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16270 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016271 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016272 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016273
16274The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16275allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16276as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16277while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16278real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16279delay.
16280
16281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162828.1. Log levels
16283---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016284
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016285TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016286source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016287HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16288in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16289track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16290syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16291about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016292
16293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162948.2. Log formats
16295----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016296
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016297HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016298and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16299slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16300options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016301
16302 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16303 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16304 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16305 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16306 extents.
16307
16308 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16309 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16310 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16311 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16312 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16313
16314 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16315 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16316 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16317 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16318 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16319
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016320 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16321 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16322 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16323 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16324
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016325 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16326
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016327Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16328specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16329field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16330servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16331always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16332identifier.
16333
16334Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16335 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16336 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16337 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16338 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16339
16340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163418.2.1. Default log format
16342-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016343
16344This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16345as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16346format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16347
16348 Example :
16349 listen www
16350 mode http
16351 log global
16352 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16353
16354 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16355 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16356 (www/HTTP)
16357
16358 Field Format Extract from the example above
16359 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16360 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16361 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16362 4 'to' to
16363 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16364 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16365
16366Detailed fields description :
16367 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16368 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16369 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16370 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16371 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16372 and processed the connection.
16373 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16374
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016375In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16376"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16377connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16378
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016379It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16380will eventually disappear.
16381
16382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163838.2.2. TCP log format
16384---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016385
16386The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16387is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16388information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16389counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16390emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16391environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16392the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16393sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016394specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16395not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16396fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16397marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016398
16399 Example :
16400 frontend fnt
16401 mode tcp
16402 option tcplog
16403 log global
16404 default_backend bck
16405
16406 backend bck
16407 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16408
16409 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16410 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16411 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16412
16413 Field Format Extract from the example above
16414 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16415 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16416 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16417 4 frontend_name fnt
16418 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16419 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16420 7 bytes_read* 212
16421 8 termination_state --
16422 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16423 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16424
16425Detailed fields description :
16426 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016427 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16428 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16429 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016430 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016431 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016432 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016433
16434 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016435 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16436 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16437 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016438
16439 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16440 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16441 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016442 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16443 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16444 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16445 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016446
16447 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16448 and processed the connection.
16449
16450 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16451 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16452 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16453 applications.
16454
16455 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16456 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16457 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16458 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16459 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16460
16461 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16462 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16463 See "Timers" below for more details.
16464
16465 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16466 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16467 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16468 "Timers" below for more details.
16469
16470 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016471 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016472 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16473 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16474 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16475 details.
16476
16477 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16478 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16479 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16480 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16481 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16482
16483 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16484 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16485 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16486 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16487 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16488 for more details.
16489
16490 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016491 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016492 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16493 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16494 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016495 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016496
16497 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16498 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16499 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16500 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16501 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16502 caused by a denial of service attack.
16503
16504 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16505 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16506 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16507 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16508 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16509 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16510 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16511 denial of service attack.
16512
16513 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16514 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16515 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16516 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16517 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16518 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16519 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16520 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16521 be processed than on other servers.
16522
16523 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16524 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16525 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16526 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16527 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16528 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16529 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16530 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16531 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16532 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16533 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16534 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16535 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16536
16537 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16538 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16539 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16540 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16541 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16542 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016543 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016544 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16545
16546 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16547 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16548 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16549 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16550 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16551 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016552 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016553 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16554 occurs.
16555
16556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165578.2.3. HTTP log format
16558----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016559
16560The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16561is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16562the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16563are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16564emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16565generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16566"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16567which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016568frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16569is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016570
16571Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16572slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16573with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16574
16575 Example :
16576 frontend http-in
16577 mode http
16578 option httplog
16579 log global
16580 default_backend bck
16581
16582 backend static
16583 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16584
16585 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16586 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16587 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016588 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016589
16590 Field Format Extract from the example above
16591 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16592 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016593 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016594 4 frontend_name http-in
16595 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016596 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016597 7 status_code 200
16598 8 bytes_read* 2750
16599 9 captured_request_cookie -
16600 10 captured_response_cookie -
16601 11 termination_state ----
16602 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16603 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16604 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16605 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16606 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016607
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016608Detailed fields description :
16609 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016610 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16611 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16612 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016613 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016614 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016615 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016616
16617 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016618 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16619 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16620 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016621
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016622 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16623 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016624
16625 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16626 and processed the connection.
16627
16628 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16629 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16630 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16631
16632 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16633 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16634 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16635 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16636 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16637 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16638
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016639 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16640 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16641 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16642 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16643 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16644 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016645 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16646 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016647
16648 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16649 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016650 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016651
16652 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16653 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016654 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16655 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016656
16657 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16658 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16659 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16660 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16661 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016662 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16663 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016664
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016665 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16666 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16667 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16668 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16669 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16670 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16671 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016672 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016673
16674 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16675 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16676 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16677
16678 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16679 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16680 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16681 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16682 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16683 overflowing.
16684
16685 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16686 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16687 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16688 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16689 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16690 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16691 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16692 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16693
16694 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16695 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16696 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16697 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16698 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16699 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16700 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16701 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16702
16703 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16704 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16705 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16706 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16707 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16708 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16709 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16710
16711 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016712 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016713 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16714 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16715 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016716 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016717 system.
16718
16719 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16720 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16721 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16722 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16723 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16724 caused by a denial of service attack.
16725
16726 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16727 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16728 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16729 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16730 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16731 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16732 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16733 denial of service attack.
16734
16735 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16736 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16737 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16738 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16739 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16740 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16741 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16742 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16743 processed than on other servers.
16744
16745 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16746 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16747 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16748 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16749 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16750 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16751 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16752 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16753 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16754 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16755 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16756 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16757 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16758
16759 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16760 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16761 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16762 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16763 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16764 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016765 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016766 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16767
16768 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16769 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16770 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16771 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16772 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16773 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016774 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016775 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16776 occurs.
16777
16778 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16779 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16780 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16781 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16782 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16783 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16784 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16785 cookies" below for more details.
16786
16787 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16788 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16789 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16790 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16791 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16792 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16793 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16794 and cookies" below for more details.
16795
16796 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16797 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16798 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16799 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16800 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16801 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16802 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16803 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16804
16805
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168068.2.4. Custom log format
16807------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016808
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016809The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016810mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016811
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016812HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016813Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16814separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16815prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16816
16817Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16818variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016819("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016820
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016821If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016822as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016823less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16824the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16825
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016826Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016827In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016828in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016829
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016830Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16831'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16832https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16833such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16834
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016835Flags are :
16836 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016837 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016838 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16839 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016840
16841 Example:
16842
16843 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16844 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16845
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016846 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16847
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016848At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16849
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016850 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16851 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016852
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016853the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016854
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016855 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16856 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16857 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016858
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016859and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16860
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016861 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16862 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016863
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016864Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16865
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016866 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016867 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016868 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16869 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16870 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016871 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16872 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16873 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016874 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016875 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16876 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016877 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016878 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16879 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016880 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016881 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016882 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016883 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016884 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016885 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016886 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016887 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16888 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16889 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16890 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16891 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016892 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016893 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16894 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016895 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016896 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16897 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016898 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16899 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16900 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016901 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016902 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16903 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016904 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016905 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16906 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16907 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016908 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016909 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016910 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16911 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16912 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16913 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016914 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016915 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016916 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016917 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016918 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016919 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016920 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16921 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16922 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016923 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016924 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16925 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016926 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016927 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16928 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016929 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016930 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016931 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016932 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016933
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016934 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016935
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016936
169378.2.5. Error log format
16938-----------------------
16939
16940When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16941protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16942By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16943"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016944will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016945logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16946
16947The format looks like this :
16948
16949 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16950 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16951 Connection error during SSL handshake
16952
16953 Field Format Extract from the example above
16954 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16955 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16956 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16957 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16958 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16959
16960These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16961failures.
16962
16963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169648.3. Advanced logging options
16965-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016966
16967Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16968just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16969options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16970for more information about their usage.
16971
16972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169738.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16974------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016975
16976It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16977haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16978commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16979monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16980ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16981
16982 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16983 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16984 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16985 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16986
16987 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16988 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16989 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016990 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016991 such as other load-balancers.
16992
16993 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16994 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16995 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16996
16997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169988.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16999----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017000
17001The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17002what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17003or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017004"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017005just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17006log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17007after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17008is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17009with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17010with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17011
17012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170138.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17014------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017015
17016Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17017for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17018"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17019retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17020raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17021a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17022file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17023you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17024"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17025
17026
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170278.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17028--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017029
17030Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17031multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17032them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17033"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17034logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17035error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17036and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17037too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17038useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17039alternative.
17040
17041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170428.4. Timing events
17043------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017044
17045Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17046reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17047the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17048frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017049mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17050addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17051
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017052Timings events in HTTP mode:
17053
17054 first request 2nd request
17055 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17056 t tr t tr ...
17057 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17058 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17059 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17060 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17061 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17062
17063Timings events in TCP mode:
17064
17065 TCP session
17066 |<----------------->|
17067 t t
17068 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17069 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17070 |<------ Tt ------->|
17071
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017072 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017073 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017074 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17075 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17076 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017077 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017078 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17079 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17080 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17081 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017082
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017083 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17084 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17085 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017086 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17087 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17088 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17089 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17090 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17091 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017092
17093 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17094 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17095 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17096 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17097 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17098 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17099 request typed by hand during a test.
17100
17101 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17102 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017103 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017104 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17105 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17106 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17107 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017108
17109 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17110 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17111 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17112 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17113 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17114
17115 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17116 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17117 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17118 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17119 connection never established.
17120
17121 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17122 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17123 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17124 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17125 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17126 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17127 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17128 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17129 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17130 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17131 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17132
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017133 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17134 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17135 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17136 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17137 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17138 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17139
17140 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17141
17142 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17143 "Ta" can never be negative.
17144
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017145 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17146 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017147 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17148 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017149 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017150
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017151 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017152
17153 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017154 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17155 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017156
17157These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17158protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17159that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017160due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17161"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17162that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017163
17164Most common cases :
17165
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017166 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17167 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17168 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17169 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17170 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17171 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17172 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17173 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17174 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17175 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17176 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017177 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017178
17179 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17180 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17181 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17182 of ms on remote networks.
17183
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017184 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17185 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17186 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017187
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017188 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17189 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17190 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17191 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17192 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17193 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17194 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17195 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17196 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017197
17198Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17199
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017200 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017201 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017202 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017203
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017204 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017205 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17206 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17207
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017208 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017209 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17210 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17211 flags.
17212
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017213 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17214 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017215 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17216 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17217 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17218 the client connection was maintained open.
17219
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017220 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017221 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017222 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017223 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17224
17225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172268.5. Session state at disconnection
17227-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017228
17229TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17230"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
172312-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17232each of which has a special meaning :
17233
17234 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17235 session to terminate :
17236
17237 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17238
17239 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17240 server explicitly refused it.
17241
17242 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17243 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17244 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17245 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017246 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017247
17248 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17249 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017250
17251 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17252 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17253 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17254 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17255 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17256
17257 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17258 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17259 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17260 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17261 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17262
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017263 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17264 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17265
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017266 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17267 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17268 backup connections when going up.
17269
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017270 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17271
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017272 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17273 send or receive data.
17274
17275 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17276 send or receive data.
17277
17278 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17279 with nothing left in the buffers.
17280
17281 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17282
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017283 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017284 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17285
17286 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17287 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17288 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17289 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17290 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17291
17292 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17293 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17294
17295 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17296 server (HTTP only).
17297
17298 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17299
17300 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17301 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17302 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17303
17304 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17305 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17306 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17307
17308 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17309
17310 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17311 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17312
17313 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17314 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17315 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17316
17317 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17318 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017319 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17320 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017321
17322 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17323 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17324 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17325 another server.
17326
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017327 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017328 server.
17329
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017330 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17331 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17332 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17333 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17334
17335 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17336 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17337 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17338 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17339
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017340 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17341 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17342 "use-server" rule).
17343
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017344 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17345
17346 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17347 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17348
17349 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17350
17351 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17352 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17353 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17354
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017355 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17356 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017357 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017358 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17359 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17360
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017361 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17362
17363 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17364 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17365
17366 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17367
17368 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17369
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017370The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17371was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017372helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17373starvation, attacks, etc...
17374
17375The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17376alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17377easier finding and understanding.
17378
17379 Flags Reason
17380
17381 -- Normal termination.
17382
17383 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17384 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17385 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17386 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17387
17388 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17389 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17390 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17391 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17392 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17393 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017394
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017395 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17396 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017397 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017398
17399 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17400 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17401 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17402
17403 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17404 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17405 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17406 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17407 the server takes too long to respond.
17408
17409 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17410 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17411 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17412 long a time to respond.
17413
17414 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17415 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17416 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17417 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017418 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17419 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017420
17421 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17422 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17423 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17424 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17425 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017426 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017427 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17428 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17429 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17430 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17431 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17432 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17433 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17434 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017435 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017436 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17437 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17438 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017439
17440 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17441 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017442 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17443 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17444 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17445 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017446
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017447 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17448 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017450 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017451 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17452 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017453 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017454 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17455 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17456
17457 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17458 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17459 503 or 504 here.
17460
17461 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17462 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17463 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17464 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17465 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17466
17467 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17468 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017469 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017470 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17471 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17472
17473 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17474 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17475 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17476 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17477 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17478 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17479 between haproxy and the server.
17480
17481 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17482 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17483 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17484 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17485 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17486 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17487 solution is to fix the application.
17488
17489 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17490 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17491 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17492 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17493 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17494 external attacks.
17495
17496 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17497 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017498 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017499 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17500 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17501
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017502 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17503 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17504 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017505 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017506 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017507
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017508 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17509 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17510 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17511 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017512 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17513 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17514 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17515 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17516 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017517
17518 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17519 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17520 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17521 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17522
17523 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17524 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17525 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17526 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17527
17528 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17529 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17530 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17531 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17532
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017533The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17534persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17535important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17536re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17537
17538 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17539
17540 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17541 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17542 set on a GET request.
17543
17544 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17545 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017546 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017547 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17548
17549 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17550 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17551 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17552
17553 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17554 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17555 already got a cookie.
17556
17557 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17558 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17559 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17560 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17561 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17562
17563 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17564 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17565 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17566
17567 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17568 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17569 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17570
17571 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17572 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17573
17574 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17575 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17576 then advertised in the response.
17577
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175798.6. Non-printable characters
17580-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017581
17582In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17583consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17584converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17585prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17586being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17587escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17588is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17589'}' when logging headers.
17590
17591Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17592issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17593containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17594
17595Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17596the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17597performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17598
17599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176008.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17601---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017602
17603Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17604achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017605section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017606cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17607the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17608the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017609locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017610not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17611user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17612a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17613wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17614
17615 Examples :
17616 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17617 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17618
17619 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17620 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17621
17622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176238.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17624---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017625
17626Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17627proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17628the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17629server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17630
17631Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17632response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017633section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017634
17635It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017636time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17637appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017638are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17639and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17640follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17641request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17642in the logs.
17643
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017644As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17645frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17646an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17647
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017648 Example :
17649 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17650 listen proxy-out
17651 mode http
17652 option httplog
17653 option logasap
17654 log global
17655 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17656
17657 # log the name of the virtual server
17658 capture request header Host len 20
17659
17660 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17661 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17662
17663 # log the beginning of the referrer
17664 capture request header Referer len 20
17665
17666 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17667 capture response header Server len 20
17668
17669 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17670 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17671
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017672 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017673 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17674
17675 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17676 capture response header Via len 20
17677
17678 # log the URL location during a redirection
17679 capture response header Location len 20
17680
17681 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17682 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17683 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17684 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17685 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17686
17687 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17688 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17689 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17690 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017691 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017692
17693 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17694 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17695 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17696 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17697 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017698 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017699
17700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177018.9. Examples of logs
17702---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017703
17704These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17705them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17706reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17707
17708 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17709 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17710 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17711
17712 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17713 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17714
17715 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17716 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17717 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17718
17719 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17720 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17721
17722 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17723 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17724 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17725
17726 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017727 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017728 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17729 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17730
17731 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17732 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17733 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17734
17735 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17736 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017737 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017738 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17739 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17740 to return the 502 and not the server.
17741
17742 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017743 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017744
17745 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17746 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17747 Nothing was sent to any server.
17748
17749 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17750 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17751
17752 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17753 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017754 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017755 send a 408 return code to the client.
17756
17757 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17758 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17759
17760 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17761 5 seconds ("c----").
17762
17763 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17764 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017765 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017766
17767 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017768 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017769 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17770 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17771 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17772 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17773 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017774
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017775
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200177769. Supported filters
17777--------------------
17778
17779Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17780accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17781unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17782
17783See also : "filter"
17784
177859.1. Trace
17786----------
17787
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017788filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017789
17790 Arguments:
17791 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17792 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17793
17794 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17795 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17796 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17797 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17798
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017799 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017800 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17801 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17802 amount of the parsed data.
17803
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017804 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017805
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017806This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17807callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17808information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17809filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17810
17811Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17812tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17813a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17814
17815
178169.2. HTTP compression
17817---------------------
17818
17819filter compression
17820
17821The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17822keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017823when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17824it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17825response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17826line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17827cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17828the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017829
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017830See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017831
17832
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200178339.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17834--------------------------------------------
17835
17836filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17837
17838 Arguments :
17839
17840 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17841 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17842 parsed.
17843
17844 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17845 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17846 part must be placed in its own scope.
17847
17848The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17849external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017850streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017851exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17852also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17853
17854SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17855the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17856
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017857For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017858"doc/SPOE.txt".
17859
17860Important note:
17861 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17862 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17863
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100178649.4. Cache
17865----------
17866
17867filter cache <name>
17868
17869 Arguments :
17870
17871 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17872
17873The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17874"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17875cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017876other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17877the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17878mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17879filter other than the compression is used for the same
17880listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17881order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017882
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017883See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017884
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001788510. Cache
17886---------
17887
17888HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17889(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17890RAM.
17891
17892The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017893this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017894
17895If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17896independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17897when we try to allocate a new one.
17898
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017899The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017900
17901It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17902"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17903for more details.
17904
17905When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17906replaced by "<CACHE>".
17907
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001790810.1. Limitation
17909----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017910
17911The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17912
17913- If the response is not a 200
17914- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017915- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017916- If the response is not cacheable
17917
17918- If the request is not a GET
17919- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017920- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017921
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017922Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
17923filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
17924can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
17925example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
17926"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017927
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001792810.2. Setup
17929-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017930
17931To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17932the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17933
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001793410.2.1. Cache section
17935---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017936
17937cache <name>
17938 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17939 size of cache is mandatory.
17940
17941total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017942 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017943 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017944
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017945max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017946 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17947 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17948 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017949
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017950max-age <seconds>
17951 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17952 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17953 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17954 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17955 default.
17956
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001795710.2.2. Proxy section
17958---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017959
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020017960http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017961 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17962 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17963 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17964 after this one.
17965
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020017966http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017967 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17968 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17969 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17970 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17971
17972
17973Example:
17974
17975 backend bck1
17976 mode http
17977
17978 http-request cache-use foobar
17979 http-response cache-store foobar
17980 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17981
17982 cache foobar
17983 total-max-size 4
17984 max-age 240
17985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017986/*
17987 * Local variables:
17988 * fill-column: 79
17989 * End:
17990 */